Volum Afases 2014
Volum Afases 2014
Volum Afases 2014
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Presidents ship:
Commander Vasile BUCINSCHI, PhD
Brigadier General Boris URKECH, PhD
Members:
Professor Rzvan - Lucian ANDRONIC, PhD
Colonel Mihail ANTON, PhD
Professor Hamid R. ARABNIA, PhD
Brigadier General Ghi BRSAN, PhD
Commander Mircea BOCOIANU, PhD
Professor Gavrila CALEFARIU, PhD
Professor Ivan Menes CAMEJO, Doc
Associate Professor Sergiu CATARANCIUC, PhD
Professor Constantin -Edmond CRACSNER, PhD
Professor Aurel CRIAN, PhD
Researcher Maria DINESCU, PhD
Professor Philippe DONDON, PhD
Professor Constantin DUGULEAN, PhD
Professor Ctlin Marius GHERASIM, PhD
Lecturer Mihaela GURANDA,PhD
Professor Vladimir HORAK, CSc
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
ORGANIZING COMMITTEE
President:
LTC Laurian GHERMAN,PhD
Members:
Prof. Ion DINESCU, PhD
Capt. Cmd. Ionica CRCIU, PhD
Maj. Cornel ARAM, PhD
Lt.col. Danut BLOS
Lt.col. Cristian ENE
WO. Vasile PRISACARIU
Assist. Prof. Liliana MIRON, PhD
Assist. Prof. Constantin STRMBU, PhD
Assist. Prof. Cristian CONSTANTINESCU, PhD
Maj. Ctlin CIOAC, PhD
Math. Carmen URSOIU
Assist. Prof. Math. Gheorghe RADU, PhD
Assist. Prof Mihaela GURANDA, PhD
Assist. Prof Mihaela SMEADA, PhD
Assoc. Prof. Diana ILIOI, PhD
Assist. Bogdan Gheorghe MUNTEANU
Assist. Daniela NAGY
Logistics:
Col Dumitru DINU
Maj Bogdan CHIOSEAUA
Lt Cosmin TTULESCU
WO Marian MIHALACHE
Secretariat:
Maj Criste RU
Capt. Roxana ANTOCHE
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
CONTENTS
Pag
AIR FORCE
Drago Cristian ACHIEI, Petric VIZUREANU, Mirabela Georgiana MINCIUN,
Bogdan ISTRATE, Andrei Victor SANDU
PHASES ANALYSIS AND STRUCTURAL CHARACTERIZATION OF CuAlMnFe
ALLOY
Vladimr BEO, Frantiek ADAMK Jr
UNMANNED COMBAT AIR VEHICLE: MQ-9 REAPER
Oliver CIUIC, Marcel PREDESCU, Eduard MIHAI
PLAYING WITH THE SAFETY DUE TO LACK OF RESOURCES
Ionic CRCIU , Andrei LUCHIAN
THEORETICAL ASPECTS RELATED TO FLIGHT SAFETY SYSTEMS IN EARLY
WARNING AIR TRAFFIC CONFLICT
Ion DINESCU, Gabi MOLDOVAN, Ovidiu MOSOIU
EXPERIMENTAL RESEARCH REGARDING THE MANUFACTURING
OF THE ANTI FRICTION MATERIALS USED IN AERONAUTIC
CONSTRUCTIONS
Adrian-Ioan LI, Ioan PLOTOG, Lidia DOBRESCU
MULTIPROCESSOR SYSTEM DEDICATED TO MULTI-ROTOR MINI-UAV
CAPABLE OF 3D FLYING
Doru LUCULESCU
THE DRIVELINE ANALYSIS OF HYPER SUSTENTATION DEVICES
Eduard MIHAI
PRECISION APROACH SYSTEM BASED ON GLOBAL NAVIGATION SATELLITE
SYSTEM
Alexandra PALLA PAPAVLU, Fabio DI PIETRANTONIO, Domenico CANNAT,
Massimiliano BENETTI, Enrico VERONA, Valentina DINCA, Thomas LIPPERT,
Maria DINESCU
GAS SENSORS FABRICATED BY LASER-INDUCED FORWARD TRANSFER
Manuela-Cristina PERJU, Petric VIZUREANU, Carmen NEJNERU
THE STUDY OF ENERGY TRANSFER ON THIN LAYERS ACHIEVED BY
ELECTRO-SPARK DEPOSITION WITH TiC ELECTRODE
Vasile PRISACARIU, Andrei LUCHIAN
THE AERODYNAMIC ANALYSIS OF HIGH LIFT DEVICES
Marius RADULESCU, Vasile SANDRU
CONSIDERATIONS ABOUT THE LIFE EXTENSION PROGRAMS BY TECHNICAL
RESOURCE RENEWAL APPLIED TO THE SURFACE-TO-AIR MISSILES
13
19
25
31
35
41
47
53
57
65
69
77
83
97
695
103
109
117
121
127
133
141
149
153
157
165
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
175
179
185
191
197
205
213
221
227
233
241
251
259
267
275
279
283
291
297
301
305
311
317
325
331
335
341
347
353
361
365
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
MANAGEMENT
Arina CIUREA, Anior NEDELCU
ANALYSIS OF THE INSTRUMENTS AND TECHNIQUES USED FOR TOTAL
QUALITY MANAGEMENT. APPLICABILITY AND IMPLICATIONS IN THE
EDUCATIONAL SYSTEM.
Gherasim Solovestru DOMIDE, Alexandru DOMIDE
VEHICLE DAMAGE PROFIT DECREASE FACTOR FOR THE ROMANIAN
INSURANCE MARKET
Constantin DUGULEAN, Steliana BUSUIOCEANU
AUTOREGRESSIVE MODELS USED IN THE STUDY OF
LABOR MARKET
Liliana DUGULEAN, Constantin DUGULEAN
CHANGES IN TOP 10 EUROPEAN BRAND CORPORATIONS DURING THE
ECONOMIC CRISIS
Flavia FECHETE, Anisor NEDELCU
ANALYSIS OF THE ECONOMIC PERFORMANCE OF A ORGANIZATION USING
MULTIPLE REGRESSION
Alexandru Florin MGUREANU
FEW ASPECTS REGARDING THE PRINCIPLES OF ENVIRONMENTAL
PROTECTION IN THE EU
Alexandru Florin MAGUREANU , Ioan TEFU
ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AND ARMED CONFLICTS IN NATIONAL AND
INTERNATIONAL REGULATIONS
Mria PETRUFOV Eva RVAYOV
EMOTIONAL INTELLIGENCE OF MANAGER AS BASED ASSUMPTION OF
MANAGER COMPETENCES IN AIR FORCE ACADEMY CONDITIONS
Ioan PITICAR
THE INTERALLIED CONFEDERATION OF RESERVE OFFICERS- CIOR, AND
PERSPECTIVE OF RELATION WITH EX-SOVIET UNION (E-SU) STATES IN THE
CONTEXT OF CRIMEA CRISIS.
ROLES OF THE PARAMILITARY ORGANIZATIONS AND MILITIA OF ETHNIC
MINORITIES IN THE POLITICAL AND MILITARY TURBULENCE THEATRE
Marian SFETCU
ANALYSIS OF THE POSSIBILITY OF PROVIDING A COMPLEX MOTIVATIONAL
SYSTEM FOR PUBLIC INTERNAL AUDITORS BY MANAGEMENT
Ioan UNEA, Grigore VASILIU, Simona SPIRIDON
BEYOND THE FAST-FOOD MODEL OF EDUCATION. IS THE SCHOOL
CAPABLE TO FOSTER CREATIVITY?
Ioan UNEA, Grigore VASILIU, Simona SPIRIDON
THE BLIND MEN AND THE ELEPHANT A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF THE
ROMANIAN STRATEGY FOR RDI
9
369
375
381
387
397
403
407
411
423
431
441
447
10
453
457
461
465
471
477
489
497
501
509
519
527
533
541
547
553
559
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
11
565
571
577
585
589
603
609
615
619
625
631
639
647
Marilena TICUSAN
SCHOOL DROPOUT IN CURENT SOCIETY
Otilia Anca TODOR
THE ROLE OF THE FEUERSTEIN INSTRUMENTAL ENRICHMENT PROGRAM
IN THE SOCIO-EMOTIONAL DEVELOPMENT OF CHILDREN
Otilia Anca TODOR
COGNITIVE EDUCATION AND R. FEUERSTEINS CONCEPT ON MEDIATED
LEARNING
Florin VANCEA
PERSONALITY, IDENTITY AND PSYCHIC MATURITY
Petronela Sorina VRBAN, Florin Marian ANTONESCU
INMATES PERCEPTION, MOTIVATION AND FEELINGS TOWARDS SCHOOL
ON EDUCATIONAL ACTIVITIES CONDUCTED IN GIURGIU PRISON
Loredana VCU
BECOMING A PSYCHOTHERAPIST
Corina Mihaela ZAHARIA, Grigore DUMITRU
BioSpecter PSYCHOMETRIC SYSTEM OR EXPERT SYSTEM OF PERSONALITY
EVALUATION
12
653
659
665
671
677
685
689
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The paper presents a study on alloy CuAlMnFe, analyzed in terms of phases and structural
aspects and physical and mechanical properties, after some heat treatments like annealing, quenching
and tempering.
Keywords: aluminum bronzes, micro-hardness, constituents
1. INTRODUCTION
13
AIR FORCE
Bearing pivoting
for medical
applications[3]
ne na 3 2 ;
- phase - is formed on the basis of a novel
compound of formula Cu32Al19 electronic and
electronic concentration and the changes in the
ordering phenomena due to solid state at
780...870C [1,9] .
phase stable at high temperature
undergoes
eutectoid
decomposition
temperature of 570 C and 11.8 % Al :
570 C
'.
Clutch
components for
ship winch system
[4]
Rough-cast wheel
gearbox [4]
Fittings [7]
Six propeller
blades used to
propel the ship. It
weighs 107 tons
and is 9.1 meters
in diameter [6].
Al
100 92.5
92.5 91
91 88.2
88.2 84
0 ... 7.5
7.5 9
9 11.8
11 16
Equilibrium
constituents
after slow
cooling
annealing
+
+
Equilibrium
constituents
after rapid
cooling
quenching
+
+
+
2. EXPERIMENTAL TESTS
a. Chemical compositions determination
Chemical composition determinate by
spectral analysis, made on Foundry Masters
optical spectrometer, is presented in table 3.
Cu
88.8
14
Zn
Sn
0.0985 0.0053
Mn
1.97
Table 3
Fe
0.741
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Si
Cr
0.0637 0.0265
Al
8.19
As
Co
0.0097 0.015
Scope of analysis was between 2 = 20120, step size being 0.0010, and the time step
is 3 seconds / step.
It was used a proportional detector with a
single channel, the analysis is performed as
Gonio.
The analysis of copper alloys by X-ray
diffractometry, the samples will be obtained
from the system alloy, Cu-Al-Mn-Fe section
having 15 mm and sample length 20 mm.
Figure 2 shows the diffraction pattern obtained
for alloy CuAlMnFe - after annealing.
AIR FORCE
d. Dilatometric analysis
The purpose of the experiments is the
record length (l) that a sample undergoes
when subjected to a certain temperature.
Dilatometer L75 is suitable for both the
expansion and the contraction of the sample.
Dilatometer analysis in this paper was
performed using differential dilatometer
L75H/1400 LINSEIS type (fig. 5).
Using large samples promotes good
accuracy for determining elongation, instead
using small samples ensures a good
temperature control precision and repeatability
of results.
To obtain accurate and repeatable
experimental data is recommended that the
dilatometer to work with relatively low speeds
of approx. 5 to 10 C/min.
The heating rate was required for the
experiment at 10 C/min.
16
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Quenching
Tempering
328.73
304.83
270.41
217.02
184.91
208.24
301.32
203.39
17
100X
200X
Fig.9. Alloy microstructure, annealing state,
ammonium persulfate attack.
100X
200X
Fig.10. Alloy microstructure, quenching state,
ammonium persulfate attack.
AIR FORCE
100X
200X
Fig.11. Alloy microstructure, tempering state,
ammonium persulfate attack.
In annealing state, the studied bronze has a
homogeneous structure composed by solid
solution, recrystallized
in the form of
polyhedral grains with macles and phase, in
smaller quantity and uniformly distributed.
After quenching and tempering heat
treatments application, in the structure in
addition to Solid solution phase, appear and
phase, which improve the mechanical
characteristics of alloy.
3. CONCLUSIONS
Phases composition of the unit cell
structure and characteristics of each phase
identified were determined by X-ray
diffraction, and the main objective was to
determine
the
phase
composition,
microstructure and of alloy composition
CuAlMnFe after applying heat treatments
annealing, quenching and tempering.
Physical and structural characteristics
analyzed in the paper falls within the specific
parameters of the alloy and can guarantee a
18
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Currently are increasingly we meet with the term flying unmanned aerial vehicles or also
drones. Also gets are into the awareness of the notion unmanned combat air vehicles, also known as
UCAV. Among the best known means of unmanned aerial vehicles in categories UCAV include MQ-9
Reaper, also known as the Predator B.
Keywords: Unmanned Combat Air Vehicle, UCAV, MQ-9 Reaper, Predator, Aircraft
1. INTRODUCTION
Unmanned combat air vehicle MQ-9 Reaper
belongs to a group of defense systems and its
primary purpose is finding, tracking and
destruction of land and sea targets. This flying
unmanned combat aerial vehicle has a
wingspan of 20 meters and a length of 11
meters. Maximum weight of take-off is 4,763
kg, can carry 1361 kg load externally, ie. in
underslung and 386 kg load internally in the
fuselage.
Fig.2 Drawing MQ-9 Reaper from above and
from the front
19
AIR FORCE
2. CONSTRUCTION
Aircraft structure is composed primarily of
advanced materials. It is a composite materials
made mostly up of carbon fiber, these
materials constitute up to 89% of the airframe
structure. Such a high percentage of these
materials contribute to the low weight of the
aircraft and the prolongation of its range.
TPE331-10
of
Reaper
with
underslung
4. ARMAMENT
The primary armament which are uses for
unmanned combat air vehicle MQ-9 Reaper is
constituted of missiles AGM-114R known as
Hellfire II which weighing 100 pounds and are
designed to destroy armored objects on land
and sea. Using modern semi-active laser head
allows the launch also from great heights,
which is for the unmanned aerial vehicles very
important in view of their higher operational
flight levels. Due to higher flight levels is
reached even higher angle of impact of the
missile to target which increases her
effectiveness and thanks to the new navigation
unit is more accurate. Another frequently used
armament in MQ-9 Reaper are laser-guided
500-pounds aerial bomb termed as GBU-12
Paveway II. These bombs using modern
advanced semi-active laser-guidance warhead
20
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
5. SYSTEMS
5.1 AN/AAS-52 System
Multi-spectral surveillance and targeting
system (MTS-B) AN/AAS-52 includes
electro-optical, laser and infrared sensors for
detecting, tracking and labeling of objects and
targets. Allows remote monitoring of targets in
high resolution, determine their distance,
coordinates and label for Hellfire missiles, as
well as for all laser-guided munitions NATO.
The whole system is composed of two main
parts and namely from rotating tower unit,
which is located in the inferior front part of the
MQ-9 Reaper and electronic optical unit,
which is located in fuselage UCAV. This
system also allows for lighting targets, is
designed to be modular and can be
complemented with various optical sensors for
different wavelengths, as well as additional
electronic circuitry, allowing wide-spectral use
of the system and as well its development.
21
AIR FORCE
<85kg).
6. Control
22
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
6. CONCLUSIONS
23
REFERENCES
AIR FORCE
24
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper deals with one of the common issue of the flight safety organization: limited
resources for Air Forces. Is it better to look forward for next days or for the next years? That is the
question. The article shows how the safety has to be, which are the steps of flight safety in aviation
history, and why the defense area from Swiss cheese model of J. Reason has to start from the top
management of organization. The paper argues that a collective understanding of these issues is essential
for those systems seeking to achieve an optimal safety culture to be able to maintain the requested level of
capabilities, with minimum resources, in the actual worldwide context.
Keywords: safety culture, Air Force, resources, management, capabilities, training.
1. INTRODUCTION
Flight safety. Two words. In fact it is a
condition for airmen. Flight safety will never
be just a task in aviation. It should be a way of
life from the beginning until the end of story
for each and any individual linked to aviation
(pilots, air traffic controllers, maintenance
personnel, managers... ).
It's main goal is to prevent the loss of
aviation resources.
Flight safety is the desired condition
gained by organizations through their
individuals in order to be able to forecast air
operations risks and produce a positive attitude
for safe use of the resources using the right
procedures, services, skills and knowledge to
reduce to a minimum level the risks to air
operations.
Basically, it is a puzzle built by each
member of an organization and everyone
having their own personality, behavior, and
temperament.
25
2. SAFETY CULTURE
Risks in aviation vary depending on the
stage of aviation development. The history of
progress in aviation safety can be divided into
three eras [1].
Technical era - from the early 1900s
until the late 1960s
First attempts to build, fly, and control
an object heavier than the air had its tribute. In
the beginnings, identified safety deficiencies
were initially related to technical factors and
technological failures due to the lack of
knowledge. The focus of safety was on the
investigation and improvement of technical
factors. During the two World Wars, aviation
was seen as a very effective tool in the battle
field and also an important element of the
transportation industry that was constantly
growing. Technological improvements starting
in the early 1950s, were the first step in
decreasing the frequency of accidents and the
flight safety process started to be upgraded.
AIR FORCE
SAFETY ORGANIZATION
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
AIR FORCE
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
AIR FORCE
2.
30
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The quick evolution of global demographic component and the intense increase in the number
of aircrafts of all types, resulted a significant congestion of air routes especially in areas near large
airports. To meet the new demands of air traffic services we must modernize and implement new systems
for flight safety. Air collision risk is still present and therefore is remarket the idea and concept of
accepting a standardized and effective warning system.
1. INTRODUCTION
Since the 1950s, international civil aviation
forums discussed the concept and development
of a system to avoid collisions. ICAO
(International Civil Aviation Organization) has
developed standards for ACAS (Airborne
Collision Avoidance Systems).
ACAS is designed to operate independent
of both the navigation systems of the aircraft
and ground equipment used for the provision
of air traffic services [1,2]. Airborne Collision
Avoidance System (ACAS) is the ultimate
method accepted at global level regarding
search and solve critical situations of air traffic
between aircrafts.
The system mainly consists of the
implementation of ACAS equipment onboard
31
AIR FORCE
2. ROLE
The functionality of TCAS is based on the
transponder on board. The level of protection
provided by TCAS equipment depends on the
type of transponder which operates with the
nearby aircrafts. So it is obvious that TCAS
can provide protection against an aircraft not
(1),
(2),
3Dexpressionrateswheretheindicesx,yaxes
are horizontal coordinate system and z is the
altitude.
On the horizontal dimension the amount of
protection is not defined only by the distance
threshold, but also for a estimated buffer .
However it depends on the size and speed of
the
aircraft
head
intruder.
The first implementation of a mandatory
collision avoidance system, TCAS II, was
requested in the airspace of the United States
starting with30 December 1993. All civil
32
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
with
ACAS
II
and
starting from January 1, 2005, all civil
fixedwing aircraft and turbine engine
having a maximum takeoff over 5700
kg, or a maximum approved
configuration for passenger seats more
than 19, will have to equip themselves
withACASII,[7,8,9].
3. COMPOSITION
TCAS II system components
A TCAS II (Figure 3) [1, 4, 11, 12].
Is composed of:
a computer - which processes
information regarding airspace surveillance,
coordinates and tracking potential dangerous
aircrafts, detect potential threats, calculate and
determine avoidance maneuvers and making
33
AIR FORCE
34
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The designing of a product which must be fulfilled by the product, thus it is worth to mention
the issue of selecting the material out of which that particular product will be made.
The experimental researches are those concerning the assurance of high mechanical and physical
characteristics under special regimes, where as the weight of the finished product must be minimized by
diminishing the density of the samples.
Thispaperpresentsafewcharacteristicsofmaterialsusedintheproductionoffrictionmaterials
usedintheaeronauticconstructions.
Keywords: manufacturing,material,frictionbearings,aeronautic,construction.
1. INTRODUCTION
35
2. MATERIALS USED
At present, the main categories of metallic
materials used in the production of friction
(radial, axial and hydrostatic) are the following
ones: [2, 4]
- alloy from the Lead-Tin system;
- cast piece or sintered Cooper-based alloy;
- Aluminium-based alloy;
- other alloys etc.
The tin based alloys (babbit the
composition 88% Sn, 8% Sb and 4% Cu). This
alloy has rapidly become the most frequently
used in the production of anti-friction
AIR FORCE
36
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
37
AIR FORCE
4. EXPERIMENTAL RESEARCH
The materials used in the production of the
friction pieces for which there have been used
samples and have been carried out studies and
experimental research are the following ones:
[1, 3, 4]
- Al-Sn plated on the steel support;
- Cu-Pb sintered powders on steel support.
AS20 (Steel Support Plated with AntiFriction Material: 20% Tin, 1% Copper, the
rest - Aluminum).
CP10S10 (Steel Support with Anti-Friction
Material Sintered from: 23% Lead, 10% Tin,
the rest - Copper).
These samples are presented in Figure 1.
a
Fig. 1. Samples of Materials Used
b
Fig.3. Fixed semi couplings (sintering materials)
38
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
39
AIR FORCE
40
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The paper describes an electronic multiprocessor system that assures functionality of a
miniature UAV capable of 3D flying. The apparatus consists of six independently controlled brushless
DC motors, each having a propeller attached to it. Since the brushless motor requires complex
algorithms in order to achieve maximum torque, efficiency and response time a DSP must be used. All the
motors are then controlled by a main microprocessor which is capable of reading sensors (Inertial
Measurement Unit (IMU)-orientation and GPS), receiving input commands (remote controller or
trajectory plan) and sending independent commands to each of the six motors. The apparatus contains a
total of eight microcontrollers: the main unit, the IMU mathematical processor and one microcontroller
for each of the six brushless DC motors. Applications for such an apparatus could include not only
military, but also search-and-rescue, geodetics, aerial photography and aerial assistance.
.
Keywords: hexacopter, brushless, IMU, search-and-rescue, BLDC
1. INTRODUCTION
Vertical take-off and landing (VTOL)
vehicles have been developed in the past
century starting with the helicopter. The main
advantages between VTOL vehicles and
airplanes is hovering over a small area and
being able to operate in areas with no runway.
Comparing to a helicopter, having six
propellers instead of two highly increases the
useful
payload,
the
stability
and
maneuverability. Multi-rotor systems (with 4,
6 or 8 propellers) can run faster, maintain
stability in tougher winds and execute turns
much faster (also used in aerobatics) than a
traditional helicopter [1]. The main drawback
of such systems is that building gas-powered
41
AIR FORCE
42
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
AIR FORCE
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Fig. 8. Hexacopter.
45
AIR FORCE
46
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
plain flap
split flap
slotted flap
Fowler flap
AIR FORCE
Fig. 2.1 The kinematic mechanism for operating the rigid flaps
l0
Fig. 2.2 Rigid kinematic mechanism for actuating the flaps (CAD solution)
2.2.Theoretical considerations.
The kinematic analysis of the
articulated plan mechanism analyzed
previously assumed structural analysis of
48
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
parameters
mechanism
(defining
parameters) and the independent coordinates
(input data).
The necessary reference system is adopted
and the flap actuator relations between the
unit vectors of the reference relatively to the
base. In every contour considered a
independent mechanism we each attach our
own verse and fixed unit vector establish our
own basic expressions for reference system.
The stated problem for the analyzed case, is
the vector equations which is written for
each of the independent contours closing
mechanism.
The equations reveal the unknown
vector and closing through appropriate
algebraic operations, we determined the
necessary scalars and most importantly the
law of motion transmission. We can
determine successive derivations which
require angular velocity and acceleration
kinematics
torso
writing
(reduced
appropriately to chosen points). To control
the flaps mechanism in the embodiment
shown in Figure 2.2 it is necessary to
determine the speed and acceleration
functions.
We took into consideration the
geometry mechanism in Figure 2.2 and
Table 2.1 data analysis.
Tabel 1. Data analisys
Element antrenare l1l2
Element execuie l9
Timp de analiz
Unghi levier 1
Unghi flaps 9
500 mm
500 mm
3s
400
450
49
AIR FORCE
1
9
Fig. 2.3 The kinematic representation of a optimized rigid flap actuator SAM 6.1
x(1)
[m]
0.576
0.545
0.519
0.497
0.479
0.467
0.461
y(1)
[m]
1.187
1.157
1.124
1.088
1.05
1.009
0.967
x(9)
[m]
3.7
3.703
3.744
3.799
3.857
3.907
3.926
y(9)
[m]
0.272
0.276
0.33
0.416
0.536
0.703
0.949
3. CONCLUSIONS &
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
50
3.1.Conclusions
The kinematic analysis of the
mechanism can build a driveline of
dimensional design commands for a simple
type of damper flap.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3.2. Acknowledgment
2
3
4
5
51
AIR FORCE
52
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Unfortunately,
typical,
ground-based
navigation aids failed to keep up with the
global navigation requirements and modern
aircraft. The old method of navigation through
the use of a sextant and dead reckoning is just
not adequate for modern day systems. The
development, initially by the United States, of
a global system providing positioning and
timing services allowed the introduction of an
alternative to those conventional navigation
and approach aids with the possibility of using
new concepts in air navigation capable of
satisfying the new needs of the aeronautical
community.
The
International
Civil
Aviation
Organization (ICAO) had actively promoted
the use of Global Navigation Satellite System
(GNSS). A wide area of applications have
already demonstrated the enormous benefits to
be gain from onboard Global Positionong
System (GPS) receivers, including safety
enhancements. In air operations, GPS accuracy
streamlines enroute and terminal navigation,
53
AIR FORCE
SATELLITE/GNSS
AIRCRAFT
GROUND
Satellite subsystem:
provides satellite status, position and
timing signal;
has sufficient number of satellites to
determine user position.
Ground subsystem provides:
pseudorange corrections for each
satellite in view;
integrity of aircraft subsystems
(protects against satellite signal errors,
ground
subsystem
errors
and
anomalous ionospheric errors);
approach paths (Final Approach
Segment FAS for all runway ends);
local
tropospheric
parameters,
necessary to adjustment;
predicted availability for precision
approaches and estimates aircraft
protection levels against alert limits.
Aircraft Subsystem:
applies
broadcast
pseudorange
corrections (PRCs);
computes position using corrected
PRCs only;
computes deviations from broadcast
approach path;
determines if GBAS Landing System
(GLS) approach is safe;
54
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
REFERENCES
1. Article. Source. [online]. Available:
http://instrument.landing-system.com
(accessed at March,2014)
2. BONNOR, A. C. N., A Brief History of
Global Navigation Satellite Systems, The
Journal of Navigation, Volume 65 (2012)
55
3.
EUROCAE
ED-114
Minimum
Operational Performance Specification for
Global Navigation Satellite Ground Based
Augmentation System Ground Equipment to
Support Category I Operations EUROCA
4. ICAO, Annex 10 to the Convention on
International Civil Aviation, Volume I Radio
Navigation Aids, International Civil Aviation
Organization, Sixth Edition (2006);
5. ICAO, Annex 14 to the Convention on
International Civil Aviation International Civil
Aviation Organization, Sixth Edition (2006);
6. ICAO, Doc 8071, Vol. II - Manual on
Testing of Radio Navigation Aids, Testing of
Satellite-based Radio Navigation Systems,
Fifth Edition, 2007
7. ICAO, Guide for Ground Based
Augmentation System Implementation, 2013
8. Tarnowski, E. Airbus Indsutrie Engineering
Test Pilot. Source. [online]. Available:
https://www.youtube.com
(accessed
at
March,2014)
AIR FORCE
56
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This work summarizes the developments in dynamic release layer (DRL) assisted LIFT of
complex materials such as polymers, biomolecules, or carbon nanotubes for applications as recognizing
elements in miniaturized surface acoustic wave (SAW) resonators and chemiresistor devices.
As the functionality of such sensors depends on the applied laser source, target material, and transfer
geometry, first an optimization of the process parameters is reported.
Following a morphological and structural characterization of the active material, the performance, i.e.
the sensitivity, resolution, and response time of the laser-printed devices was evaluated by exposure of the
sensor arrays to different toxic vapors. Different sensitivities and selectivity to the selected chemical
agents i.e. dimethyl methylphosphonate, dichloromethane, dichloropentyhane, ethyl acetate, etc. have
been measured thus proving the feasibility of LIFT for applications in sensors and biosensors.
Keywords: laser-induced forward transfer, surface acoustic wave, sensors, chemiresistors
1. INTRODUCTION
Environmental monitoring due to air
pollution is a problem of current interest both
for the industry, i.e. automotive (detection of
polluting gases from cars) as well as for many
research groups. Since sensors are the main
components in products and systems used to
detect volatile organic compounds (VOCs) in
air, there are always new and innovative
sensor technologies emerging. Several key
requirements for sensors include sensitivity,
the minimum concentration of target gases
57
AIR FORCE
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
59
AIR FORCE
60
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
AIR FORCE
62
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
63
AIR FORCE
64
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Electro-spark deposition method is a
current research method, used for coating by
deposition on installation components, which
works in hard conditions, abrasive wear, in
moist or dry environment, in order to obtain
superficial layers of superior tribological
qualities. Obtaining thin layers with special
properties
(wear
resistance,
corrosion
resistance and shock resistance) requires a
proper choice of filler material, in strict
correlation with the physical and mechanical
properties of the material support, [1,2,3,6,7].
Discharge parameters regimes (voltage,
current and pulse time), depends on the
physico-chemical properties of the electric and
working circuit (device-electrode-piece).
In this context, we can say that the
parameters depend on the type of electrode
deposition, and its melting temperature, the
thermal conductivity, chemical reactivity of
65
AIR FORCE
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
66
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3.1. Deposition regimes for TiC. Singlepulse energy deposition of titanium carbide
electrode has large fluctuations, ranging from
4510-3 J (r1, A4) and 492,810-3 J (r4, A4).
Energy increases and decreases randomly with
regime change and amplitude of vibration. The
mean value for the 48 experiments is Emedium=
161,8310-3 J, (Fig. 2).
Fig. 2. Energy variation depending on the amplitude operating mode and working regime for TiC
electrode.
67
AIR FORCE
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Fig. 3. Power variation depending on the amplitude operating mode and working regime for TiC
electrode.
4. CONCLUSIONS
Correlation
amplitude
regime
and
deposition electrode and the base material type
is important, both in terms of energy
consumption and in terms of technology in
order to achieve uniform deposition without
burning achieve, pores or overlapping
material. Energy analysis of deposits reveals
that the energy deposit is inversely
proportional to the size of electrical discharge
pulse resistance.
REFERENCES
1. S. Frangini, A. Masci, A study on the effect
of a dynamic contact force control for
improving electrospark coating properties,
Surface & Coatings Technology 204, pp.
26132623, (2010).
2. Liu Dongyan, Gao Wei, Li Zhengwei,
Zhang Haifeng, Hu Zhuangqi, Electro-spark
deposition of Fe-based amorphous alloy
coatings, Materials Letters 61, pp. 165167,
(2007).
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: High lift devices (DHS) are designed to expand the flight envelope by changing the
local geometry (mechanization wing), they generally camber changes depending on the phase of flight
(landing, take-off). As controls, the aircraft they developed aeromechanical has effects with implications
for the resistance structure of the wings, and the most important effect is the twisting of the wing. The
article desires a analysis of the 2D aerodynamic profile with changes in curvature at trailing edge.
Keywords: high lift devices (HLD), Clark Y, Javafoil 2.20, XFLR5 6.09, Profili 2.21
1.INTRODUCTION
High lift devices used for bearing
surfaces are designed to expand the flight
envelope by changing the local geometry
(wing mechanization) according to phases of
flight of the aircraft. Figure 1.1 is an example
of this general concept
Vat at
1.winglet, 2.low speed aileron, 3.high speed aileron,
4.flap track fairing, 5.Krger flaps, 6.slats, 7.three
slotted inner flaps, 8.three slotted outer flaps, 9.spoilers,
10.spoilers-air brakes
69
Fzat
V2
2
S c zat
(1)
(2)
where:
at - factor influencing soil landing, (0.94
0.96);
Air density;
G Weight of airplane;
S Lifting surface;
Czat lift coefficient in landing configuration
AIR FORCE
Chart Cz-
V - speed
Fz at lifting in landing configuration
In Figure 1.3 the most common types
of flaps lifting surfaces.
Plain flap
Split flap
Slotted flap
Fowler flap
70
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
71
AIR FORCE
121 pct
100000
Viscosity
Air density
1,46 x 10-5
1.221 kg/m3
72
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
AIR FORCE
Flap 00
V/V
3.2. Acknowledgment
Cp
Flap 15
V/V
BIBLIOGRAFIE
1
2
Cp
Flap 300
4
5
6
V/V
Cp
Fig. 2.13 Flow velocity distribution
3. CONCLUSIONS &
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
3.1.Conclusions
The main effect of flaps is a generating
flow vortex separation on the upper side
especially in areas of the surface with air
74
http://aviationknowledge.wikidot.com/aviati
on:wing
http://herschlogbook.blogspot.ro/2012/07/ae
rodynamics-flight-controls.html
Young
A.D.,
The
aerodynamic
characteristics of flaps, RAE technical
report Aero no. 2622, London, 1953, 56p.
http://www.zenithair.com/stolch801/design/
design.html,
http://www.airliners.net/aviationforums/tech_ops /read.main/281872/
Weisshaar, T.A. (2006) Morphing Aircraft
Technology New Shapes for Aircraft
Design. In Multifunctional Structures /
Integration of Sensors and Antennas.
Meeting Proceedings RTO-MP-AVT-141,
Neuilly-sur-Seine, France: available at :
http ://www.rto.nato.int/abstracts.asp,
Prisacariu V., Ru C., Introduction
morphing technology in unmanned aircraft
vehicles (UAV), AFASES 2011: The 13th
International Conference of Scientific
Papers SCIENTIFIC RESEARCH AND
EDUCATION IN THE AIR FORCE, mai
2011, Braov, Romania, , 6p
Barbarino S., Bilgen O., and others, A
review of morphing aircraft, Journal of
intelligent material systems and structures,
Vol.22/2011, DOI:10.1177/1045389X1141
4084, p55.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
http://soni2006.hubpages.com/hub/ThrustVectoring-Sukhoi,
Hepperle M., JavaFoil 2.20, JAVAFOIL
Users Guide, 2014, 44p., disponibil la
http://www.mhaerotools.de/airfoils/javafoil.htm
Duranti S. Profili 2.21 software, 2012,
Feltre-Italia, www.profili2.com, consulted at
12.02.2014
Drela M., Yungren H., Guidelines for
XFLR5 v6.03 (Analysis of foils and wings
operating at low Reynolds numbers), 2011,
http://sourceforge.net/projects /xflr5/files;
Airfoils database, consulted at 10.02.2014,
http://airfoiltools.com/airfoil/details?airfoil=
clarky-il
Mestrinho J.R.C., Felicio J.M.I., and others,
Design optimization of variable-span
morphing wing, 2nd International Conference
on Engineering Optimization, September
2010, Lisbon, Portugal, 11p.
Williams J., Butler S.F.J., Wood M.N., The
aerodynamics of jet flaps, no. 3304, London,
1963,
35p.,
dsiponibil
la
http://naca.central.cranfield.ac.uk/
75
AIR FORCE
76
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The work-paper presents few considerations regarding the opportunity that a life
extension program to be applied in the case of a ground-to-air missile as an Air Defense Missile System
(ADMS) component. A model of a hypothetical AD missile is built and serves as a base for the technical
and economical reasons for the extension life decision. Using some market data for the missiles
components, the authors try to balances the life-extension costs with those of the complete replacement
ones. The scientific, technical and technological support needed for applying such a program is set also.
The conclusions refer to the multitude of the factors which are involved in the life extension program
management.
Keywords: missile, lifecycle, efficacy, program, costs
1. INTRODUCTION
The air power represents the main force
multiplier of an armed force. This assertion
allows the huge efforts make by the owners to
maintain the advance of the aerial features in
the endowment. Any military organization
must be able to counter the aerial menace at an
appropriate technological level. This level is
done today by the Air Defense Missile
Systems (ADMS) using the air defense (AD)
missile or SAMs. If the aerial means evolves
for increasing survivability and efficacy, the
ADMSs and the SAMs default must keep the
same trend [3].
This implies the quickly change the SAM
generation every time when the aerial threat
significantly change the characteristics or the
continuously up-grade of the existing ADMS
until the consumption of their operational life.
77
AIR FORCE
Fuse
Guidance
Warhead
Sustainer
Booster
78
Fuse
Checking on
stands
200
64
10150
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Fuse
Guidance
Booster
Warhead
[kg]
1
2
3
4
5
Guidance Unit
Proximity fuse
Warhead
Sustainer rocket motor
Booster rocket motor
Sum
12
8
15
67
18
120
[USD/lb
]
10400
7400
4800
4200
3600
Estimated
price *
Component
Cost
indicator
Weight
Section
Operation
1
Battery
replacement
Interfaces refit
Checking on
stands
Checking on
stands
[USD]
275500
130500
159000
621000
143000
1329000
79
Guidance
(cost /
pcs)
Fuse
600
80
13900
200
64
10150
Estimated
price
[USD]
Material
cost
[USD]
AIR FORCE
Warhead
(cost / pcs)
Sustainer
(cost / pcs)
Booster
(cost / pcs)
Airframe
(cost / pcs)
SubAssembly
tests
(cost /
batch)
Delivery
(cost / pcs)
Final test
(cost /
batch)
Technolog
ical
documenta
tion
(cost /
batch)
1
Dismantle
Cleaning
Destroy of the
old charge
Recharging
with new
explosives
Replacement
of igniters
Assembly
Dismantle
Cleaning
Destroys of
the old fuel
Recharging
with fuel
Replacement
of igniters and
squibs
Assembly
Dismantle
Cleaning
Destroys of
the old fuel
Recharging
with fuel
Replacement
of igniters and
squibs
Assembly
Missile
general
checking
Sections
dismantle
Interfaces refit
Compartments
checking
Assembly
Capacity tests
after refitting
Technolo
gical
devices
1500
16
5400
Cote
4800
88
22750
1600
48
10900
300
64
12100
4200
420
290
100
16
6600
420
6390
660
for 310 missiles
1200
3240
1600
1
Including
USD 66000
third-part cowork
10 missile of
1,33 USD
million each
of batch
destroyed
Total
7700
2160
4
1420
0
42900
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
where
WACC weighted average cost of capital
I0initialinvestment
i
- numbers of years before cash flow
occurs
NPV must be > 0 in order to consider the
project feasible.
If some uncertainty of budgetary cash flow
is considered, respectively did exist 50 50
percent chance to have in the second year an
allowance of 25 USD millions or down at 20
USD millions, according [8] we can calculate
the NPV as:
=0.5max[16.666+17.361,0]+0.5max
[16.666+13.888,0]=0.3475+0=0.35>0
4. CONCLUSIONS &
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
A superior process aiming to an extended
life cycle of a technical system a missile
peculiarly is represented by the up-grade
program, which can be applied to few or all
the system components. But such a process is
most expensive and in many cases requires
unavailable know-how type technical data.
81
Previous*
USD / FY
USD
FY13
AIM-9L
84,000 / 1999
185,500
AIM-120C
400,000 / 1998
567,700
SM-2ER
409,000 / 1981 1,032,470
AIM-9
Sidewinder
AIM-120
AMRAAM
RIM67/174
Standard
*data from [10], [12], [13], [14]
Following*
USD FY13
AIM-9X
664,900
AIM-120D
1,492,000
SM-6ERAM
4,284,000
Growth
258 %
163 %
315 %
245 %
AIR FORCE
82
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper presents a mathematical model of an unsteady fluid flow around an airfoil where the
time dependency is introduced through the boundary conditions. The methods of solution that were
developed for these models included the treatment of the zero normal flow on a solid surface and the use
of the unsteady Bernoulli equation. As a result of the nonuniform motion, the wake becomes more
complex than in the corresponding steady flow case and therefore the path along which the airfoil moves
was assumed to be prescribed. One of the more difficult aspects of the unsteady problem is the modeling
of the vortex wakes shape and strength, which depend on the time history of the motion. In the paper the
wake shed from the trailing edge of the lifting surfaces was modeled by vortex distributions.
Keywords: unsteady aerodynamics, vortex flow, airfoil circulation
1. INTRODUCTION
In an incompressible and irrotational fluid
flow, the velocity field can be obtained by
solving the continuity equation. However, the
incompressible continuity equation does not
directly include time-dependent terms and the
time dependency is introduced through the
boundary conditions. The methods of solution
for steady flows can be used with only small
modifications that include the treatment of the
zero normal flow on a solid surface boundary
conditions and the use of the unsteady
Bernoulli equation. As a result of the
nonuniform motion, the wake becomes more
complex than in the corresponding steady flow
case and it should be properly accounted for.
The unsteady motion of the surface on
which the zero normal flow boundary
83
y
Inertial frame
of reference
p
x
X
Starting
vortex
AIR FORCE
where R = (X , Y , Z ) .
On the other hand, the Kelvin equation
could be an additional condition for the
unsteady flow, that can be used to determine
the stream wise strength of the vorticity shed
into a wake, so, the circulation around a
fluid curve enclosing the body and its wake is
conserved,
d / dt = 0
(3)
Because of the boundary condition this
problem becomes time dependent and it could
be solved easier in the body-fixed coordinate
system
[2].
A
transformation
from
(X, Y, Z ) coordinate system to (x , y, z )
coordinate system should include the
translation and the rotation of the (x , y, z )
system and may have the following form
0
0
x 1
y = 0 cos(t ) sin (t )
z 0 sin (t ) cos(t )
cos(t ) 0 sin (t )
0
1
0
sin (t ) 0 cos(t )
cos(t ) sin (t ) 0
sin (t ) cos(t ) 0
0
0
1
X X0
Y Y0
ZZ
0
r
The kinematic velocity v of the
undisturbed fluid due to the motion of the
airfoil as viewed in the body frame of
reference is given by
r
r r
r
r
v = V0 + v rel + r
(4)
where
r
& ,Y
& , Z& )
V0 = (X
0
0
0
r
&
&
&
(
)
v
=
x
,
y
,
z
rel
(5)
r
= (p, q, r )
rr = (x, y, z )
remains unchanged, 2 = 0 .
2. WAKE SHAPE
84
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
(10)
v = / Y
w = / Z
=
= ( )2 +
t
2
2
2
2
1
=
+
+
+
2 X Y Z t
=
t inertial
(12)
r
r r
V0 + r , , , +
x y z t body
2 x y z
r
r r
V0 + r +
t
2
r
= (0, 0, 0)
(13)
r
n = (sin , 0, cos )
Z
r
n
(11)
85
AIR FORCE
or
+ U , 0,
(sin , 0, cos ) = 0
z
x
The above scalar product has the form
(15)
+ U sin +
cos = 0
z
x
therefore
(16)
=
+ U tan
z
x
(t1 )
Bound
vortex
Collocation
point
t =0
w1
(t 2 )
w 2
w1
t1 = t
U t
t2 = 2 t
U 2t
2
2
4
This equation can be rewritten in the form
(18)
w body + w wake + U sin = 0
which indicates that the sum of the normal
velocity induced by the airfoil, w body , by the
wake, w wake , and by the free stream must be
zero.
(t1 ) =
1 1
1
2 c c + 1 U t
2 4 2
(20)
U sin
=
w1
1 1
1
2 c c + 1 U t
2 4 2
c
c 1
2
2 + U t
2
4 2
w 2
= U sin
+
2 c + 1 U t + U t
4 2
(t 2 ) + w 2 + w 2 = 0
c
c 1
2 + U t
2
2
4 2
w 2
w1
+
=
c 3
c 5
2 + U t 2 + U t
4 2
4 2
= U sin
(t 3 ) + w 3 + w 2 + w1 = 0
86
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
c
c 1
(t i )
=
2 + U t
2
2
4
2
wi
1
1
i 1
w (i j)
U sin
j=1 2 c + (2 j + 1) U t
4
2
i 1
wj
j=1
wi =
wi (t )U dt
(21)
t t
( x, t )
(t )
X
Path of
w1 trailing
d
U (t ) t
4. WORTEX DISTRIBUTION
U (t )
U (t )
(t )
(t )
wi
w i 1
w i 2
w i 3
U (t )t U (t )t U (t )t U (t )t
Fig. 4. Discretization of the wakes vortex distribution
87
AIR FORCE
r
rotation, = 0, & (t ), 0 and n is the normal
vector to the surface
x , 0, 1
(23)
n=
1 c (x 0 , t )
B
dx 0
=
2 0 x x 0
z
(26)
w &
(x , t )
(t ) x
z
t
with the Kutta condition (c, t ) = 0 .
Based on the classical approach of Glauert,
a similar solution to the vortex distribution is
1 + cos
(, t ) = 2U(t )A0 (t )
+ A n (t )sin n
sin
n =1
where
A 0 (t ) =
1 w (x , t )
d
0 U(t )
2 w (x , t )
A n (t ) =
cos nd
0 U (t )
3c
U A 0 + 4 t (U A 0 ) +
L(t ) = c
+ U 2 A1 + c (UA ) + c (UA )
1
2
2 4 t
8 t
U2
7c
(U A 0 ) +
A0 +
2
8 t
M 0 (t ) = c 2
2 U2
3c
(U A1 )
A1 +
+
8 t
2
U2
c
(
U A 2 )
A2 +
8 t
c 2 4
2 c
32 t (U A 3 )
+1
x
If the wake potential is known from the
previous time steps then
B B w
=
+
+ U & z
z
x
x
x
(24)
w &
x +
z
t
On the other hand, the downwash induced
by the airfoil bound circulation (x, t ) with
assumptions presented above is
1 c (x 0 , t )
(x , t )
dx 0 = U(t )
2 0 x x 0
x
(25)
6. NUMERICAL RESULTS
88
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
50
100
150
Time discretization
L = U (t ) + t (t ) c
(30)
D = w (x, t )(t ) + (t ) c
w
t
One important parameter used in the
description of unsteady aerodynamics und
unsteady airfoil behavior is the reduced
frequency, k, defined as k = c / (2V ) , where
is the angular frequency, c is the chord of
the airfoil and V is the flow velocity.
According to the dimensional analysis, the
resultant force, F, on the airfoil of chord c,
can be written in functional form as
F / V 2c2 = f (Re, M, k ) . For k = 0 the flow
is steady and for 0 k 0.05 the flow can be
considered quasi-steady, that is, unsteady
effects are generally small. Flows with
characteristic reduced frequencies above of
0.05 are considered unsteady [1].
The lift amplitude and phase of lift for pure
angle of attack oscillations are presented in
Fig. 7 and Fig. 8, where the significance of the
apparent mass contribution to both the
amplitude and phase can be appreciated.
200
= (U , 0, 0) +
(27)
t
Taking into account that
(x, 0, 0) = (x )
(28)
2
x
the pressure difference between the airfoils
lower and upper surface is
(x )
=
p = pl p u = 2 U
+
2
t
(29)
x
= U (x ) + (x )dx
t 0
For the lumped-vortex method there is only
one airfoil vortex and therefore the lift and
drag per unit span are
89
AIR FORCE
100
80
60
40
20
0
20
1
Circulatory
Total response
2
k
Apparent mass
REFERENCES
90
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This article deals with current problems of evalution of the effectivity of radars protection against
electroning jamming. The first part examines experience with electronic warfare in local conflicts and electronic
countermeasures. The paper presents basic notions and division of electronic jamming.
The second part describes a new method of evaluating effectivity of influence of electronic jamming on
radars activity. Using Saaty method of multifunctional evaluation in computer environment gives distinctioned
values to differcut sorts of jamming. The example of Air Defence missiles system SA 6 Gainfull shows the
possibility of using this methodic.
Introduction
A plane has gone missing. Not a small one,
but a large Boening, Malaysia Aerlines with
more than two hundred people on board and
nobody can find it. It is just China that admit
they have more than 20 satellites in that region
monitoring the area. Nobody knows how many
satellites do the USA, Russia, Great Britain
and France have, but we can assume that it
might be far more. And in spite of that, a plane
goes missing. Could this be caused by
Martians? Or are we witnessing another
electronic war, the results of which will be
known in 20 or 30 years? We should
remember what the electronic war is and when
it arose. As a consequence, smaller countries
like us should modernize radar and missile
91
Electronic war
AIR FORCE
within
the
92
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Chart 1
A1
A1
A1
A1
A1
A2
A2
A2
A2
A3
A3
A3
A4
A4
A5
9
X
x1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Chart 2
E1
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
24
23
0
22
7
3
E2
21
18
13
13
5
0
E3
E4
E5
Ei
11
24
5
20
0
5
26
19
3
13
7
0
33
27
3
5
0
6
115
111
24
73
19
14
93
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A3
A4
A5
A6
A4
A5
A6
A5
A6
A6
AIR FORCE
After determining the maximum eigenvalue of matrix and determinant of the matrix,
6 max 23
det = 0,000381
eigenvector of matrix will be the solution of homogenous set of linear equations, that will after
modification be as follows:
w1 - 0,1985 w2 0,3971 w3 0,9927 w4 1,1919 w5 1,5883 w6 = 0
w2 0,4955 w3 1,2386 w4 1,4864 w5 1,9819 w6 = 0
w3 0,9334 w4 1,2081 w5 1,5375 w6 = 0
w4 0,4010 w5 0,8071 w6 = 0
w5 1,1310 w6 = 0
Values of eigenvector after solving the
equation:
w1 = w2 = 0,3299, w3 = 0, 0574,
w4 = 0, 1857, w5 = 0,0515, w6 = 0,0455
w6 = 1, w5 = 1,1310, w4 = 1,2607
w3 = 4,0806, w2 = 7,2464, w1 = 7,2464
Ei = 21,9651
1.noiseactive
narrowbandjamming
2.noiseactive
broadbandjamming
weight
0,33
0,33
protectiondeviceinRNRL1S91
RRL1S11M1uses:
manualregulationofamplificationofreceivers;
realignmentoftransmitterfrequency;
turning off the channel of the receiver, in which
jamminghasbeendetected;
NRL1S31M1uses:
manualregulationofamplificationofreceivers;
realignmentoffrequency;
switchingonthejamming1S31M1regime;
semiautomaticmonitoringcinD;
usinginertialtracking
RRL1S11M1uses:
manualregulationofamplificationofreceivers;
realignmentoftransmitterfrequency;
turning off the channel of the receiver, in which
jamminghasbeendetected;
NRL1S31M1uses:
manualregulationofamplificationofreceivers;
realignmentofcarrierfrequency;
switchingonthejamming1S31M1regime;
semiautomaticmonitoringcinD;
usinginertialtracking
VNIScircuit
SMTcircuit(selectionofmovingtargets)
reducingamplificationofjammedchannelusingthe
RRUknob.
94
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
4. synchronous response
pulsejamming
5.synchronouspulsenon
responsejamming
6.passivejamming
0,186
0,051
0,045
VNIScircuit
SMTcircuit(selectionofmovingtargets)
reducingamplificationofjammedchannelusingthe
RRUknob.
realignmentofcarrierfrequency;
bothRRL1S11M1andNRL1S31M1
nextperiodiccompensation2xor4xsubtraction;
windcompensationcircuit(internalphasing);
SPCwithinternalphasing;
withexternalphasing.
PCR = [ 1
n
(1 Pi) ] KKV
i=1
or eventually P1 = P2 = Pi
PCR = KKV . [ 1 (1 P1)n ]
The calculation itself or the way of
defining kru has has never been stated and in
practice various values kru have been used
depending on individual literature. However, if
0,427
then value KKV =
= 0,427
1
95
AIR FORCE
1
m
1 wi
i 1
where:
m number of protection device agens
radiolocator jamming,
wj weigh of individual type sof jamming.
For the example of calculating the quality
of radiolocator the value PCR provided P1 =
0,7, when launching two rockets will be
determined by following values.
2
96
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Faculty of Materials Science and Engineering, Technical University Gheorghe Asachi of IasiRomania, Department of Technologies and Equipments for Materials Processing, Blvd. Mangeron, No.
51, 700050, Iasi, Romania
a
tzugui.andrei@yahoo.com, bpeviz2002@yahoo.com,
97
To the evolution of metallic and nonmetallic materials and building airplanes was
observed a close connection. The development
of this field, industry aircraft manufacturing
was the collaboration result between
metallurgists
specialists
and
aircraft
manufacturers. From this collaboration has
resulted efficient equipment and materials
used to improve characteristics.
Aluminium alloys are numerous, with
different and various properties. For example,
Al-Zn-Mg-Cu alloy has a low weight and that
is why it had been used with success in the
aircraft manufacturing industry. This is
highlighted in figure 1.
AIR FORCE
No test
1.
2.
3.
Average
Al Si Fe Cu Mn Mg Zn
91,7 0,294 0,522 4,850,683 1,38 0,0768
92,2 0,269 0,562 4,68 0,65 1,44 0,0356
92,2 0,269 0,565 4,590,664 1,46 0,417
92,0 0,277 0,55 4,710,666 1,43 0,517
98
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
99
AIR FORCE
5. DILATOMETER ANALYSIS
In this work we performed the analysis
using a differential dilatometer type LINSEIS
L75H/1400.
100
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Aluminium Sample 1
Aluminium Sample 2
Aluminium Sample 3
Temperature Elongation
Temperature
Elongation
Temperature
Elongation
C
C
C
m
m
m
21,5
0
20,6
0
21,2
1,6
158,8
55
135
42,9
125,5
38,9
231,4
97
232,3
97,5
226,6
94
271,9
125,1
275,2
126,1
264
120,5
307,2
140,5
311,9
142,2
302,4
139
386,6
181
389,1
183
377,7
176,5
478,4
241,5
480,4
244
468,6
235,6
550
286,6
550
291,6
549,3
275,4
Dilatometer diagram of the alloy studied is
REFERENCES
shown in figure 8. From the chart we can see
that at 275C the alloy presents a state
1. Minea, A., Aliaje de aluminium variation passing from structure +C" by Tratamente termice i echipamente de
dissolution of C" in a state of saturation.
nclzire (Aluminium alloy heat treatments of
This is important in finding the heating heating), Ed.CERMI Iai, (2006).
temperature in order to achieve heating
2. http://www.donmaxwell.com/masters
solution treatment at the variable solubility
3. Carabet, R.G., Nejneru, C., Comaneci,
line for the alloy system.
A., Researches regarding aluminium alloys
Solution quenching treatment leads to a hardening through cyclic ageing (Buletinul
solution out the equilibrium, becoming more
Institutului Politehnic din Iai, Tomul
easily processed by cold plastic deformation.
LIV,Fasc. 3-4, Secia tiina i Ingineria
Materialelor, (2008).
CONCLUSIONS
From our research we conclude the followings:
1. The studied propeller is made from hard
deformable
aluminium
alloy
AlCu4Mg1,5Mn.
2. This propeller was made by plastic
deformation, previously solution treated,
and after deformation aged, in order to offer
the necessary functioning hardness.
3. From the dilatometry analysis is observed
that between 26C and 550C there are no
phase transformations but only state
transformation, due to the Mn percent.
101
AIR FORCE
102
HENRI COANDA
STEFANIK
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
GENERAL M.R.
ARMED FORCES ACADEMY
SLOVAK REPUBLIC
Abstract: The expanding telecommunication networks start to support services closer to business control.
Covering by default air-time account information management, they are extending to monetary
operations: bank transactions, accounts interrogations, recharge control. Thanks to smartphones
proliferation the user interface is done via applications (apps) built for Android, iOS, Windows Mobile,
etc. We propose Unstructured Supplementary Service Data (USSD) integration a reliable and
universally available control medium for enhancing Business control via apps. By doing this we are
implementing a Service Creation Environment (SCE) available to the operators in emerging economies
and also for establishing immediate control in the new Internet of Things (IoT) environment.
Keywords: App, m-Business, electronic recharge, USSD, Android, Eclipse, IoT, SCE
1. INTRODUCTION
The growth in mobile applications (apps)
will represent a 77 billion market in 2017,
each user providing customized information
via 100 apps per day, according to Gardner [1].
The apps offer to the users an unrestricted
access to services. This interactive model
represents the new apps paradigm, where the
capabilities are limited only by the ability to
imagine and develop a service. This means
expanding the apps towards m-Business and
mobile devices and even wearable devices. In
2014 we are in the first stages of apps
(infotainment) and we are expecting to
continue with monetary services control
(m-Business) and cloud integration. The apps
would control a myriad of electronic devices
in the new Internet of Things (IoT)
103
2. CONTEXT
2.1 Current usage an d risks. Telecom
operators are relying on USSD frames or IVR
(Interactive Voice Response) to implement
queries from subscribers (e.g. balance query)
or to allow various operations from authorized
agents (e.g. the sales network geographically
distributed).
Using specialized Value Added Service
(VAS) solutions the operator will increase its
local presence by allowing selected individuals
(commercial agents) to take the burden of
distributing voucher and recharge to
subscribers. This model, highly successful in
emerging and developing markets (e.g. India,
Pakistan, Algeria) is allowing a fast and direct
interaction with the customer in the lack of
banking and financial infrastructure available,
very often ahead of the grid (power
infrastructure is not yet available). The
situation we have encountered is that physical
vouchers cannot be transported on the ground
(e.g. conflict zone or inaccessible due to
natural disasters). For this reason, the
electronic distribution of vouchers is needed,
and was implemented via USSD frame or
WEB interface. Considering that WEB
interface is available to only a selected number
of main agents (dealers) we are noticing that
the bulk of operations is going to be done via
USSD,
by
unspecialized
individuals.
Mitigating the access to the service is the main
concern in this case.
Any USSD frame is starting with * and
ending with #. The intermediary fields are
also separated with *. The first field in the
frame represents the short code (SC) allocated
to this type of service and it is configured
along the core network in the Public Land
Mobile Network (PLMN). An USSD frame
example
for
voucher
recharge
is
*123*123456789012# where 123 represents
the SC followed by a 12 digit hidden recharge
number (HRN) of a voucher.
Used mainly in the developing markets, the
USSD frames are especially useful in
managing the m-Business in electronic
recharge (i.e. top-up subscribers balance).
However, in some cases, like the one we have
encountered, the USSD frames are becoming
too cumbersome for easy and rapid utilization.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
External
Opportunities
channeling the new app paradigm
no other operator, currently, provides this
tool to own commercial agents
Android based smartphones have a large
market share in Middle East and
developing economies.
Threats
As the app is using USSD channel for
triggering the requests, there is no
additional risk. Password storage and login
via the app are done via Android OSs
sharedpreferences function.
Recharge subscriber
Send voucher to subscriber
Transfer credit to another agent
Transfer vouchers to another agent
Check balance for credit or vouchers
Account settings (account update)
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
5. CONCLUSIONS &
FURTHER DEVELOPMENT
The advantages in developing and using
apps come from reduced development costs
and use of already delivered platforms for
distribution (e.g. Google Play, App Store).
The apps, even after delivery and
installation in the market, remain available for
corrections and updates using the open
development environment we presented
hereby as a SCE (Service Creation
Environment).
This is compliant with the perspective of
IN (Intelligent Networks) where individual
users (e.g. juridical persons like commercial
agents) and not only network infrastructure
manufacturers/ owners/ operators can develop/
deploy/ configure/ administrate the services.
These features reduce maintenance costs as
well.
108
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The spread spectrum (SS) communications system, use a pseudo-noise (PN) code to spread
the initial bandwidth occupied by data over a bandwidth much wider. In receiver, the SS signal is
despread using the same PN code. The most difficult task to achieve in receiver is to synchronize the
locally generated PN code with the code existing in the received signal. The purpose of this paper is to
present a receiver model for code acquisition that uses two active correlators, method derived from
acquisition with active correlator. The method proposes that, in some circumstance, the synchronization
of signals to be done by delaying the received signal, not the local PN code,with the advantages in
reducing the acquisition time and signal recovery.
Keywords: communications, spread spectrum, direct sequence, code acquisition,correlator.
1. INTRODUCTION
109
2. COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MODEL
2.1 The work environment.
Given the
complexity of a SS communication system, it
is preferable that the experiments for
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
112
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
113
3. CONCLUSIONS
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
115
116
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Among the military applications of the
electromagnetic pulse (EMP), the most
common and used method is the flux
compression generation (FCG) which was the
path the project followed. The first
experiences involving the so called E-bomb
of the FCG type were conducted by the U.S.A.
and the U.S.S.R. in the late 50s (Bykov et al.,
2001).
2. FLUX COMPRESSION SIMULATION
2.1 The simulation of the flux compression
has been undertaken in a high voltage
laboratory in order to check the actual flux
compression development. The goal of this
activity was to put into evidence the flux
compression
through
the
progressive
mechanical short-circuiting of the coils rings,
according to the electrical scheme of the
117
118
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3. CONCLUSIONS
The authors take full responsibility for the contents
and scientific correctness of the paper. The main
cel
Batran
Naval
Academy,
Constanta, Romania
4. Fowler, C.M.; Caird, R.S. & Garn, B.
(1993). An introduction to explosive
magnetic flux compression generators.
Abstract, Los Alamos
5. Johns, D. (2004). Analysis of EMI/E3
Problems in Defense Applications,
Flomerics
6. Knoepfel, H. (1970), Pulsed High
Magnetic Fields, Nord-Holland
120
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The paper describes an electronic multiprocessor system that assures functionality of a
miniature UAV capable of 3D flying. The apparatus consists of six independently controlled brushless
DC motors, each having a propeller attached to it. Since the brushless motor requires complex
algorithms in order to achieve maximum torque, efficiency and response time a DSP must be used. All the
motors are then controlled by a main microprocessor which is capable of reading sensors (Inertial
Measurement Unit (IMU)-orientation and GPS), receiving input commands (remote controller or
trajectory plan) and sending independent commands to each of the six motors. The apparatus contains a
total of eight microcontrollers: the main unit, the IMU mathematical processor and one microcontroller
for each of the six brushless DC motors. Applications for such an apparatus could include not only
military, but also search-and-rescue, geodetics, aerial photography and aerial assistance.
.
Keywords: hexacopter, brushless, IMU, search-and-rescue, BLDC
1. INTRODUCTION
Vertical take-off and landing (VTOL)
vehicles have been developed in the past
century starting with the helicopter. The main
advantages between VTOL vehicles and
airplanes is hovering over a small area and
being able to operate in areas with no runway.
Comparing to a helicopter, having six
propellers instead of two highly increases the
useful
payload,
the
stability
and
maneuverability. Multi-rotor systems (with 4,
6 or 8 propellers) can run faster, maintain
stability in tougher winds and execute turns
much faster (also used in aerobatics) than a
traditional helicopter [1]. The main drawback
of such systems is that building gas-powered
121
122
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Fig. 8. Hexacopter.
125
126
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper presents a model of stripline fractal antenna having resonant elements in the form of
a square shape. The model is presented in two versions, one with compact resonators and second with
frontier resonators, highlighting technical similarities and differences through electrical parameters. In
the same time, the paper emphasizes the concordance between theoretical and experimental results.
Keywords: fractal, stripline, antenna, directivity, field intensity.
1. INTRODUCTION
2. ANTENNA DESIGN
127
a.
b.
L11 = 15
L12 = 13
L21 = 5
L22 = 4
L31 = 3
L31 = 2
10
5
5
(3)
where: he - effective height of antenna;
N contours number;
A - surface area [m2];
- the angle of incidence of the wave
relative to antenna plane [].
L1 = 14
L2 = 4,5
L3 = 2,5
(4)
(5)
10
5
5
(6)
where fc central frequency.
According to (2), (3) N=1, A=L2 and
(7)
In case of frontier resonators the lengths
are given by
(8)
It is resulting in
(9)
(10)
(1)
(11)
(2)
where L is edge length in meters.
128
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3. EXPERIMENTAL RESULTS
Experimental data obtained by spectral
analysis (scalar) and vector analysis (with
VNA) are shown in Fig. 4 8 (experimental
diagrams).
Fig. 4 and 5 are shown the directivity
diagrams.
(17)
(18)
where hd height of the dipole.
For hd = /2,
(19)
(20)
129
130
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
2.
3.
4.
131
132
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Modernization strategy of the naval power system is based on the following: high efficiency,
high flexibility with low emissions using combined systems consisting of multiple components and various
generators. In order to simulate electro-energetic processes in the naval system and reduce fuel
consumption, we built an application that performs the energy balance in each functioning regime of a
ship by charging each consumer. The program also optimizes underway regimes, offering alternative
changes in the system and thereby reducing electricity consumption on board. The optimization provided
by the program will be made by passing the consumers in a particular type of operation in various modes
so as the total energy consumption to be the lowest.
Keywords: power system, software program, maritime ship, underway and stationary regime
1. INTRODUCTION
In
order
to
optimize
electricity
consumption correlated with increased
reliability of power systems aims in ships all
equipment and facilities to be implemented on
board must be updated along with marine
propulsion development so as a greater
efficiency and a reduced environmental impact
to be achieved. [18, 6, 17, 14]
The aim is to develop and use digital tools
to achieve combined energy production
systems. [19,15] Developing component
models at different levels of complexity,
methods for their assembly into powerful
software simulators, the use of such simulators
to analyze both the dynamic and operational
behavior while identifying limitations are very
133
3. MODEL SIMULATION
To exemplify the developed program
usage, we present an optimization algorithm
for a set of experimental values measured on
board the reference carrier Maersk LPG/NH3
Glory. This simulation model comprises a
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
136
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
137
4. CONCLUSIONS
The program will do the initial analysis of
the existing energy system and then will
optimize each regime and seek alternatives for
reducing electricity consumption thus lowering
fuel consumption of internal combustion
engines. The optimization made by the
program allows the passage of consumers from
a given running curve on another due to
regime and charge changes, therefore,
considering the calculated energy balance, the
total power consumption to be the lowest. It
also allows choosing the best alternative for
the consumers as to achieve better system
reliability and to launch windows illustrating
energy balance for standard regimes. Particular
regimes could be created as needed by
selecting the consumers. Physical and
functional integration of the power system and
automation system, optimal allocation and
power control for all subsystems are important
criteria in optimizing power consumption. The
aim was to use methods of analysis and
optimization of energy consumption so as to
realize the analysis of dynamic behavior of the
equipment with the support control and energy
management. In order to optimize electricity
consumption in correlation with the increased
reliability of power systems all equipment and
138
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
139
140
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper provides an analysis of the risk exposure of the human body to electromagnetic
fields based on the European and American reference exposure levels for the general population, in
controlled and uncontrolled environments, which are corroborated with our national documents
regarding technical norms for ship equipment and products, stipulated by the international conventions
to which Romania has adhered.
1. INTRODUCTION
In order to interpret the data measured both
with and without protective equipment, a
comprehensive documentation was carried out
based on [1, 2, 3,4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 11, 12, 13,
14].
a) recommendations by Specific Directive
96/98/EC on the "maritime equipment",
implemented in Romania by Law no.
582/2003 of the Minister of Public Works,
Transport and Housing approving technical
type norms regarding marine equipment and
products,
stipulated
by
international
conventions to which Romania has adhered,
MLPLTL.ANR-EM 2003 code;
b) SREN 55011:2001 Romanian standard
provisions industrial radio-frequency,
scientific and medical equipment (ISM). Radio
and electrical disturbance characteristics.
Limits and methods of measurement;
c) SREN 60945:2001 Romanian standard
provisions Navigation equipment and
systems, and maritime radiocommunication.
General rules. Testing methods and outcomes;
d) comparative analysis of European and
American norms regarding limits of human
141
t 80 / E ,
(1)
J = J B + J E ,
(2)
(3)
J E = k E E; k E = 0,2 ;
142
(4)
Table no. 1. Limits of field strength and power density in controlled environments, in case of continuous
exposure
Value of Electric
Field Strength
(V/m)
614
614
614/f
61,4
3.07 x f 1/2
137
Value of Magnetic
Field Strength (A/m)
35.6
1.6/f
1.6/f
0.16
8.14 x 10-3 x f 1/2
0.364
Power Density,
average value
(W/m2)
10
f/40
50
Table no. 2. Limits of field strength and power density in uncontrolled environments, in case of
continuous exposure
Field Frequency
(MHz)
0.01-0.045
0.045-1
1-10
10-400
Value of Electric
Field Strength (V/m)
275
275
275/f
27.5
143
Value of Magnetic
Field Strength (A/m)
15,6
0.7/f
0.7/f
0.07
Power Density,
average value (W/m2)
2
Field Frequency
(MHz)
400-2000
2000-300,000
Value of Electric
Field Strength (V/m)
1.37 x f 1/2
61.4
Value of Magnetic
Field Strength (A/m)
3.64 x 10-3 x f 1/2
0.163
Power Density,
average value (W/m2)
f/200
10
Table no. 3. Limits of field strength and peak power density in controlled environments
Field Frequency
(MHz)
0.01-1
1-10
10-400
400-2000
2000-300,000
Value of Electric
Field Strength (V/m)
20,000 x f 0,675
20,000/f
2000
100 x f 1/2
4500
Value of Magnetic
Field Strength (A/m)
50
50/f
5
0.25 x f 1/2
11.5
Table no. 4. Limits of field strength and peak power density in uncontrolled environments
Field Frequency
(MHz)
0.01-1
1-10
10-400
400-2000
2000-300,000
Value of Electric
Field Strength (V/m)
8700 x f 0,675
8700/f
900
45 x f 1/2
2000
Value of Magnetic
Field Strength (A/m)
22
22/f
2.24
0.112 x f 1/2
5
Table no. 5. A comparison between the European and American reference exposure levels for the
general public in controlled and uncontrolled environments
Frequency
Range
Magnetic Flux
Density (mT)
Current
Density
(mA/m2)
(rms)
0 Hz
0>1 Hz
14 Hz
41000 Hz
1.0100 kHz
0.110 MHz
0.0110 GHz
10300 GHz
40
8
8/f
2
f/500
f/500
Whole
Body
Average
SAR
(W/kg)
0.08
0.08
144
Localized
Localized
SAR
Power
SAR
(Head and
Density,
(limbs)
Trunk)
S (W/m2)
(W/kg)
(W/kg)
2
4
2
4
10
E-field Strength
(V/m)
H-field
Strength
(A/m)
B-field
(T)
Frequency
Range
01 Hz
18 Hz
825 Hz
25800 Hz
0.83 kHz
3150 kHz
0.151 MHz
110 MHz
10400 MHz
0.42 GHz
2300 GHz
10,000
10,000
250/f
250/f
87
87
87/f1/2
28
1375 f1/2
61
3.2 x 104
3.2 x 104/f2
4000/f
4/f
5
5
0.73/f
0.73/f
0.073
0.0037 f1/2
0.16
4 x 104
4 x 104/f2
5000/f
5/f
6.25
6.25
0.92/f
0.92/f
0.092
0.0046 f1/2
0.20
2. COMPARATIVE ANALYSIS OF
THE RESULTS OF FIELD
MEASUREMENTS, WITH AND
WITHOUT PROTECTIVE
EQUIPMENT
Following a well-documented research
work, our choice for comparison was "The
reference levels for occupational exposure to
electric and magnetic fields and time varying
Equivalent
Plane-Wave
Power Density
Seq(W/m2)
2
f/200
10
Table no. 6. Reference levels for occupational exposure to time varying electric and magnetic
fields, and electromagnetic fields (unperturbed RMS values)
Frequency Range
E - Electric Field
Strength (V/m)
H- Magnetic
Field Strength
(A/m)
B- Magnetic
Flux Density
(T)
Up to 1 Hz
1 8 Hz
8 25 Hz
0.025 0.82 kHz
0.82 65 kHz
0.065 1 MHz
1 10 MHz
10 400 MHz
400 2000 MHz
2 300 GHz
20,000
20.000
500/f
610
610
610/f
61
3f1/2
137
1.63 105
1.63 105/f2
2 x 104/f
20/f
24,4
1.6/f
1.6/f
0.16
0.008f1/2
0.36
2 x 105
145
2 x 105/f2
25/f
30.7
2.0/f
2.0/f
0.2
0.001f1/2
0.45
Equivalent Plane
Wave Power
Density - Sech
(W/m2)
10
f/40
50
Frequency
Range (MHz)
E - Electric
Field (V/m)
H- Magnetic
Field (A/m)
Power Density,
S (mW/cm2)
0.003 0.1
0.1 1.34
1,34 - 3
3 - 30
614
614
823,8/f
823,8/f
163
16.3/f
16.3/f
16,3/f
30 100
27.5
158.3/f1,668
100 - 300
300 - 3000
3000 15,000
15,000
300,000
27.5
-
0.0729
-
(102; 106)
(102; 104/f2)
(180/f2; 104/f2)
(180/f2; 104/f2)
(0.2; 9,4 x
105/f3,336)
0,2
f/1500
f/1500
Medium Time,
Tmed (min)
E2, S sau H2
6
6
6
6
2
f /3
6
30
6
30
0.0636f1,337
30
30
30
90,000/f
10
616,000/f1/2
147
148
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract:Some issues regarding the analysis of single-phase voltage rectifier operation will be presented
in this paper. The switch is an uncontrolled-type, a diode in this case, which is considered as an ideal
one. The expressions of the parameters characterizing the rectifier operation are computed in the paper.
Their variations depending on load are also discussed.
Keywords: rectifier, diode, single-phase
1. INTRODUCTION
The schematic of an angle-phase voltage
rectifier is presented in figure 1.
UM
i S R sin t I M sin t
i C C U M cos t
(1)
1
2
i U
C sin t
M
R2
I m sin t
149
i S i C I S e t ctg
(2)
u S R i S U M sin e t ctg
where:
UM
(3)
sin I M sin
I S
R
p ctg
sin p sin e
The following notations were used:
tg RC
R
Z
1 RC 2
UM
R
U
I
M M
Z
cos
IM
Im
(4)
2. CIRCUIT ANALISIS
UM
U
M
U d ef
p
2
I p 1 U M I M
R
I S p I M
U m p
voltage:
U
M
2
U m p
1 sin 2 e
1
cos p cos
p ctg
U d ef
(5)
U m p
U d ef
p sin p cos p A
where
(6)
sin 3
A
1 e 2 ctg
cos
I p - average value of the current
current:
I S p
I
M
2
cos p
cos
1 sin 2 e
p ctg
(8)
Limit cases:
For pure resistive load, RC 0 , 0 it
results:
p 0 0 , 90 0
(9)
(11)
UM
p
UM
(12)
I p 0
I S p 0
(10)
it results:
p 9 0 0 , 180 0
voltage:
U d ef
UM
UM
2
cos (13)
ctg
1 sin 2 e p
The k e factor:
U d ef
p
1
ke
UM
2
p sin p cos p A
(14)
unde
sin 3
1 e 2 ctg
cos
The shape factor:
k
kf e
km
The wave factor:
k u k f2 1
(15)
(16)
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1.6
1.4
8
1.3
6
kf
km
0.8
1.2
4
0.6
1.1
2
1
0.4
0.3
2
0.6
0.9
)
3 a tan( 4RC
1.2
6
1.5
7
0.2
0
0.00157
0.32
0.63
0.94
1.26
1.57
a tan( RC)
arctg (RC )
The k e factor
ke
1.
5
1.3
8
1.2
5
1.1
3
1
0.8
8
0.7
5
0.6
3
0.
5
1.
2
ku
0.
9
0.
6
0.
3
0
0.0015
7
0.3
2
0.6
0.9
1.2
3
4
a tan( RC) 6
1.5
7
arctg (RC )
151
0.3
2
0.6
0.9
)
3a tan( 4RC
1.2
6
1.5
7
arctg (RC )
1
2
(17)
k f 1.571
k u 1.21
For pure capacitive load,
RC ,
p 90 0 ,
it results:
km 1
ke 2
k f 1
ku
3. CONCLUSIONS &
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
(18)
152
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Based on the main factors which alter the durability of a structure (the loading range, the
mechanical features of the materials, the environmental and technological factors, etc.) the present paper
presents a way for assessing the aircraft structure durability. In this respect, there has been endorsed the
linear cumulative damage criterion Palmgren-Miner results, used in the assessment of average damage
level attained by the end of operating period.
Keywords: fatigue life, durability, failure, reliability
1. INTRODUCTION
2. THEORETICAL BACKGROUND
n1 n2
n
+
+ ..... + K ) = 1.0
N1 N 2
NK
(2)
where:
nK - number of loading cycles at the K th
stress level;
NK - number of loading cycles to failure for
th
the K
stress level based on constant
3.00
2.58
2.43
2.36
Number
of
Cycles
(n)
(3)
(4)=(1)+(2)
(5)=(1)-(2)
70
10
150
30
50
140
150
40
70
60
40
40
150
70
21.7
25.0
26.3
27.1
20.6
27.4
32.5
32.8
25.0
26.0
27.6
28.3
31.0
31.8
4.3
1.0
-0.3
-1.1
7.4
1.6
-3.5
-4.3
-10.0
-11.0
-12.6
-13.3
7.0
6.2
14.6
180
15.3
120
15.9
50
16.7
30
Total : 1450 cycles
24.6
25.3
25.9
26.7
-4.6
-5.3
-5.9
-6.7
(1)
13.0
14.5
7.5
19.0
10.0
154
Varying
Stress
(2)
8.7
12.0
13.3
14.1
6.1
12.9
18.0
18.8
17.5
18.5
20.1
20.8
12.0
12.8
Max.
Stress
Min.
Stress
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
REFERENCES
NC =
1000
= 17388cycles
0.05751
(3)
17388
= 5796cycles
3 .0
(4)
155
156
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
A comparative study was carried out on the
solidification of stepped parts cast from two
steels of different chemical compositions, and
from eutectic grey cast iron. In the three
studied cases both the casting temperature of
the liquid alloy and the solidification time
interval differ.
157
Figure 1 Casting
Type of alloy
Symbol
u.m.
1
2
3
0.1%C steel
0.53%C steel
Eutectic
spheroidal
graphite cast
iron
Initial
Solidus
Liquidus
temperature temperature temperature
TS
C
1495
1430
1150
0
TL
0
C
1530
1495
1150
T0ME
0
C
1685
1650
1305
158
Overheating
of the alloy
in relation to
TL
T
0
C
155
155
155
Overheating
of the alloy
in relation to
TS
T
0
C
190
220
155
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
No.
Liquid alloy
density
Specific
heat in
solid state
Symbol
u.m.
1
2
3
Kg/m3
7200
7200
6800
CS
J/kg/K
750
750
750
Specific
heat in
liquid
state
CL
J/kg/K
850
850
850
Thermal
Thermal
conductibility conductibility
in solid state in liquid state
S
W/m/K
30
29
35
L
W/m/K
28
27
30
Latent
solidification
heat
L
J/Kg
270000
270000
250000
Table 2 Results on the influence of the solidification interval on the parameters of solidification
Actual
Start time of
End time of
solidification Coordinates of
Type
of
alloy
No.
solidification solidification
the hot spot
time of hot
spot
Symbol
TSTART SOL
TSOL
tEF SOL
xNOD; yNOD;
zNOD
u.m.
s
s
s
mm
1
0.1%C steel
166.5
589.5
423.0
68,132,104
2
0.53%C steel
166.5
684.0
517.5
60;132,104
4
Eutectic spheroidal
573.0
718.75
145.75
68,132,104
graphite cast iron
c.)Eutecticspheroidalgraphitecast
iron
Figure 3 Isotherms at the end of hot spot solidification
b.) 0.53%C steel
159
160
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
161
4. CONCLUSIONS
The results presented in table 2 and in
figures 6 to 10 yield the following conclusions:
- the position of the hot spot is identical
in all three studied cases, what shows that the
solidification interval does not influence this
solidification parameter at all; this can be
explained by the fact that the dynamics of heat
transmission from the casting to the mould is
not influenced by the solidification interval, but
only by the geometry of the casting and of the
mould.
- for the same overheating in relation to
the liquidus temperature (which in this case
was T = T0M -TL =1550C) the solidification
time of the hot spot (in steels of different
chemical compositions and different solidus
and liquidus temperatures and in eutectic cast
iron) is influenced to a relatively great extent.
This influence can be. explained by the
different amounts of thermal energy (heat)
discharged by the alloy during solidification;
- in the case of steels solidification
starts at a significantly higher rate than in the
part cast from eutectic cast iron. (Table 2,
tSTART SOL OTEL = 166.5s while tSTART SOL FONTA =
573.0s); this can be explained by the
temperature difference at the initial moment
between the liquid alloy and the casting mould
(T0ME TFO ), which is significantly greater for
steels that are cast at a higher temperature; for
this reason the heat transfer from the liquid
steel to the mould immediately after filling of
the mould is much more intensive for steels,
what determines a higher cooling rate of the
alloy at the beginning of cooling in liquid state;
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
163
164
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: At the beginning of 2000s, armor technology introduced to a new material: shear thickening
fluid (STF). Due to the thickening behavior of this fluid under the stress, liquid state of the material turns
into a solid-like state in a very limited time interval. This unique behavior of STF is intended to be used in
armor systems. This paper offers an overview of STF properties and armor applications using the STF
technology.
Keywords: Shear Thickening Fluids, Armors, Aviation, Defense Industry
1. INTRODUCTION
Armor systems have a remarkable
importance for the area of security and
military. From past to present there have been
different kinds of personal armor systems used
to eliminate the attacking threats. Early
applications used bulk layers of leathers
covering around the body as the personal
armor systems. By the emerging of advance
weapons, metal armor systems came into
prominence such as steel shields. Metal armors
were safe but unfortunately heavy to act freely
during the combats. For this reason, recent
studies have been focused on ceramic
composites and light ballistic fabrics such as
aramid based fabrics.
At the beginning of 2000s, shear
thickening fluids (STF) were thought to be
used as armor materials then inevitable
development in the defense industry started.
Usage of these fluids merely or combined with
165
166
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
167
(a)
(b)
3. ARMOR APPLICATIONS
168
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
169
4. FUTURE DEVELOPMENT
STFs in armor systems are very new
technology and open to developments. This
technology provides two main improvements:
reduced weight and flexible motion. Whenever
reduction in weight comes into question, any
relation with aerospace industry may take
place. Thus, STFs can be applied to aerial
vehicles such as helicopters beside the
personal protection. Today it is just an idea
however, in the near future it might be
possible that this technology can protect the
aerial vehicles.
REFERENCES
1. A.Srivastava, A.Majumdar, B.S.Butola,
Improving the Impact Resistance of Textile
Structures by using Shear Thickening
Fluids: A Review, Crit Rev Solid State
Mater Sci, 37, 115-129, (2012)
2. L.Chang,
K.Friedrich,
A.K.Schlarb,
R.Tanner and L.Ye, Shear-Thickening
Behavior
of
Concentrated
Polymer
Dispersions Under Steady and Oscillatory
Shear, J Mater Sci, 46, 339-346, (2011)
3. W.H.Boersma, J.Laven, H.N.Stein, Shear
Thickening (Dilatancy) in Concentrated
Dispersions, AIChE J, 36, 321-332, (1990)
4. S.R.Raghavan, J.Hou, G.L.Baker, S.A.Khan,
Colloidal interactions between particles with
tethered nonpolar chains dispersed in polar
media: direct correlation between dynamic
rheology and interaction parameters,
Langmuir, 16, 1066-1077, (2000)
5. R.L.Hoffman, Discontinuous and dilatant
viscosity
behavior
in
concentrated
suspensions. II. Theory and experimental
tests, J Colloid Interface Sci, 46, 3, 491-506,
(1974)
6. R.L.Hoffman, Explanations for the cause of
shear thickening in concentrated colloidal
suspensions, J Rheol, 42, 1, 111-123, (1998)
7. B.R.Munson, D.F.Young and T.H.Okiishi,
Fundamentals of Fluid Mechanics, 5th
Edition, John Wiley & Sons, (2006)
8. R.G.Egres and N.J.Wagner, The Rheology
and Microstructure of Acicular Precipitated
Calcium Carbonate Colloidal Suspensions
170
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
171
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
Thickening:
Hard-Sphere
Colloidal
Dispersions, J Rheol, 45, 1205-1222, (2001)
M.Hasanzadeh, V.Mottaghitalab, The Role
of Shear-Thickening Fluids (STFs) in
Ballistic and Stab-Resistance Improvement
of Flexible Armor, JMEPEG, 23, 4, 11821196, (2014)
H.A.Barnes, Shear Thickening (Dilatancy) in
Suspensions of Nonaggregating Solid
Particles Dispersed in Newtonian Liquids, J
Rheol, 33, 329-366, (1989)
D.P.Kalman, R.L.Merrill, N.J.Wagner and
E.D.Wetzel, Effect of Particle Hardness on
the Penetration Behavior of Fabrics
Intercalated with Dry Particles and
Concentrated Particle-Fluid Suspensions,
Appl Mater Interfaces, 1, 11, 2602-2612,
(2009)
B.J.Maranzano and N.J.Wagner, The Effects
of Particle Size on Reversible Shear
Thickening of Concentrated Colloidal
Dispersions, J Chem Phys, 114, 1051410527, (2001)
E.D.Wetzel,
Y.S.Lee,
R.G.Egres,
K.M.Kirkwood,
J.E.Kirkwood
and
N.J.Wagner, The Effect of Rheological
Parameters on the Ballistic Properties of
Shear Thickening Fluid (STF)-Kevlar
Composites, Proceedings of NUMIFORM,
AIP Conference Proceedings, 712, 288-293,
(2004)
K.M.Beazley,
Industrial
aqueous
suspensions,
Rheometry:
Industrial
Applications, K.Walters (ed.), Research
Studies Press, Chichester, 339, (1980)
T.J.Kang,
C.Y.Kim
and
K.H.Hong,
Rheological Behavior of Concentrated Silica
Suspension and Its Application to Soft
Armor, J Appl Polym Sci, 124, 1534-1541,
(2012)
P.Bajaj,
Sriram,
Ballistic
Protective
Clothing: An Overview, Indian J Fibre &
Textile Research, 22, 274-291, (1997)
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
173
50. V.B.C.Tan,
T.E.Tay
and
W.K.Teo,
Strengthening fabric armour with silica
colloidal suspensions, Int J Solids and
Structures, 42, 1561-1576, (2005)
51. B.W.Lee and C.G.Kim, Computational
analysis of shear thickening fluid
impregnated fabrics subjected to ballistic
impacts, Adv Comp Mat, 21, 177-192,
(2012)
174
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: In this paper an approach for low-cost MEMS accelerometer static calibration is proposed.
The approach is applied to estimate the MEMS accelerometer mathematical model, including scale
factors and bias. The method does not require a three-axis rotary platform to perform perfect alignment
to the Earth gravity. The measurement is easy to perform, the calculation is simple, and the proposed
approach provides a different choice for accelerometer calibration. Experimental data is analyzed to
prove that the bias and scale factors are eliminated.
Keywords: accelerometer, bias, calibration, scale factors.
1. INTRODUCTION
By analyzing MEMS accelerometer
measurement principle and environment, it
could be proved that the main errors include
three gain factors and three biases [4, 5].
The manufacturers of the MEMS
accelerometers usually apply a calibration. The
original factory accelerometer calibration
becomes less accurate once the accelerometer
is soldered, by the end users, onto its circuit
board as a result of thermal stresses during the
soldering process.
Different approaches for recalibration are
used. Some of them require measurements in
only one or two positions of the accelerometer
[3] but only bias can be estimated. Other
approaches estimate more than 10 parameters
[1, 6]. The approaches computing six
calibration parameters are most widely used
[1, 3]. Most of these approaches require
precise orientation of the accelerometer.
175
where:
k4 S y
Sy
k3 S y
bx , by , bz
Sx , S y , Sz
are
accelerometer;
k 5 S z g x b x n x
,(1)
k 6 S z g y + b y + n y
S z g z bz n z
factors
are
for
the
random
measurement noises; k1 , k2 , k3 , k4 , k5 , k6
are installation error coefficients.
For an application demanding lower
accuracy it could be assumed that the scale
(3)
a pz = S z g pz + bz + nz
(4)
1
Apz bz = g pz
Sz
Both sides of each equation in (4) are
raised to the second power and then the
equations are summed to obtain:
A2p + 2 Apx C x 2 Apy C y 2 Apz C z + b 2 +
, (5)
+ x a x2 + y a 2y + z a z2 = 1
b 2 = bx2 + b y2 + bz2 ;
Cy = 1 + y b y ;
x =
= C x ,C y ,C z , x , y , z
p = 1 6 ;
C x = (1 + x )bx ;
C z = (1 + z )bz ;
1
1
1
1; y = 2 1 ; z = 2 1 .
2
Sx
Sy
Sz
]T ; p q ;
= C x , C y , C z , x , y , z , .
(7)
bx =
Cx
,S y =
Cz
,bz =
1+ y
Cy
,b y =
1+ x
1
Apy b y = g py .
Sy
2
2
2
, Aqx
A2px , Aqy
A2py , Aqz
A2pz ]
Sx =
1
Apx bx = g px
Sx
where:
1+ x
Apz = S z g pz + bz
(8)
1 + z
,Sz =
1+ y
. (9)
1+ z
176
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
177
178
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Advances in the Micro-Electromechanical
Systems (MEMS) technology combined with
the miniaturization of electronics, have made
possible to introduce light-weight, low-cost
and low-power chip based inertial sensors for
use in measuring of angular velocity and
acceleration [9].
MEMS accelerometers output the aircraft
acceleration which is used to obtain the
position and velocity. The accuracy of
accelerometer measurements usually depend
on different types of error sources, such as
bias, bias instability, velocity random walk,
rate random walk, etc. By integrating these
measurements in the navigation algorithm,
these errors will lead to a significant drift in
the position and velocity. To improve the
accuracy of aircraft navigation system,
different kinds of algorithms are used,
179
a k ( ) =
tk +
a (t )dt ,
(1)
tk
tk + 2
a (t )dt .
,
(7)
N
2 1
n
where N is the number of samples in the data
set.
To ensure percentage error less than 25%
the following expression is obtained from (7):
N
N
(8).
9 n
n
9
Consequently the number of clusters has to
be not less than nine.
Different types of random processes cause
slopes with different gradients to appear on the
log-log plot of Allan standard deviation [11],
as shown in Figure 1. Furthermore, different
processes usually appear in different regions of
, allowing their presence to be easily
identified [16].
(2)
tk +
d2 ( ) = (d k ( ) k )2 ,
(4)
( ) =
2
d2 ( )
.
(5)
2
Since in digital accelerometers the output
data are available in discrete form (5)
becomes:
K 1
1
(d k (nT ) k )2 , (6)
d2 (nT ) =
2(K 1) k =1
where: n is the number of samples in one
cluster; K is number of clusters; T is sample
time.
It can be shown that the percentage error
, in estimating the Allan standard deviation
of the cluster due to the finiteness of the
number of clusters is given by [10]:
bi = ( 1 )
180
2 ln(2 )
(10)
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
2
where the plot of ( ) has the slope of +0.5
for = 2 .
3. RESULTS
181
s .
(12)
182
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
4. CONCLUSIONS
REFERENCES
183
184
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The constant uses of sensors, high performance actuators, as well as informatics have imposed
an upward trend to the hardware and software electronics auto. In these situations the control and the
management of the vehicles is very important, mainly for those which have a military purpose. The need
of an on board computer diagnosis of military intervention vehicles is very useful and necessary, due, at
first, to the accoutrement of any kind of vehicle equipped with a lot of electronics equipment. Secondly,
the on board display of the operating parameters also offers the possibility to improve the vehicles
operating in order to succeed in the combat missions.
Keywords: viability, reliability, diagnosis equipment, experimental determinations.
1. VIABILITY/RELIABILITY
The viability is the reliability of the
military technique assets to which a practical
and tactical assembly of measures and
preoccupations is added (the capacity of
military technique assets and people to avoid
the wastage, to avoid in time the enemys gun
strikes and their ability to fast recover their
strike, fire, maneuvers and protection
capacities) that guarantee the fulfillment of the
intervention [1].
The reliability studies need to be done
in order to:
a) freely operate the systems on which the
vehicle depends to travel safety;
b) ensure a level of reliability suitable for
relatively simple devices, but whose failure
could attract major faults;
c) plan maintenance activities;
185
Performance
values
Constructive
and functional
characteristics
Free
operation
Durability
Characteristic situations:
* the technical criteria prevail R 1;
* the prevailing economic criteria Reconomic.
Take account of: the destination vehicle, the
user possibilities.
The viability factors of military
vehicles:
1. reliability;
2. vehicles performance;
3. efficiency of the maintainability and
maintenance works;
4. rules providing the movement;
5. combat service;
6. combat service support;
7. the quality of transport infrastructure;
8. human resources management;
9. cooperation and collaboration for
support.
From the qualitative point of view,
reliability is the ability of a device found in
given conditions of use, to perform specific
functions for a certain period of time [2].
Operating
characteristics
Level
design
Ease of
manufacture
Reliability
QUALITY
Technology
Maintainability
Conservation
The existence of
automatic protection
Level of
satisfaction of
the norms
186
Possibility of
upgrading
Use of the
quality
materials
Standardization
level
Robotics
level
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
The
approach
of
reliability,
maintenance motor performance as well as
human resources management, is mostly
similar in military and civil field.
The reliability and durability of
engines, as well as the other assemblies,
depend largely on the quality of maintenance
work carried out for every season, as well as
the quality of materials and supplies used for
this purpose. Also, the time and the quality of
intervention, how this takes place has a special
role.
Maintenance represents all the
organizational and technical activities done in
order to maintain and re-establish the technical
state of a product so that this product could
fulfill all the functions it was created for[3].
Depending on the technical condition
and the time they are performed, maintenance
can be:
- predictive;
- preventive;
- corrective;
- planned;
- based on diagnosis;
- based on state.
In the current conditions of military
actions, when the reaction rate has an
important role, and the possibilities of
unannounced interventions taken to the
extreme are also present, the use of viable
vehicles that meet successfully the imposed
requirements is impetuously needed.
The ability of technical systems of
patrol and intervention cars to function
optimally can decrease from a mission to
another by the occurrence of abnormal
functioning. They are found stored as codes in
the vehicle management system.
Errors generated on computer boards
about the engine system operation, broken
security, as well as ABS or ESP, can be
187
No
communicationintermittent;
00516 - Contact closed throttle idle-F6030-10 - Open or short circuit to B+
intermittent;
01249 - Cylinder injector 1.-N3031-10 Open circuit or short to ground
intermittent;
00532 Power supply B+
- low signal intermittent;
1316 - Control module ABS
49-10 No communication
intermittent [5].
2.2 The understanding of fault codes
Positive deviation load: the signal comes from
the air inlet circuit. It can be a problem at the
pressure regulator or at the valve that makes
the turbine not to work property;
188
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Open circuit or short to plus (B+)intermittent: sensor fault occur after cooling
circuit located on the cylinder head;
Implausible Signal: error occurs when closing
door system detects continuity in the electrical
signal;
Bus date drivetrain: failure occurs due to lock
of electrical signal on one of the relay that
sends tension to the ECU;
Open or short circuit to ground intermittent:
the code is generated due to a short circuit to
ground or to the control circuit of the given
circuit;
Low signal intermittent: in this case it is a
low voltage on the positive < 11,5v;
No communication intermittent: due to an
inappropriate tension, the command mode of
the system can not send date to ECU.
3. EXPERIMENTAL DETERMINATIONS
Monday, 25th , February, 2014,15:12:19:55062
Data version: 20100326
Addresses scanned: 01 02 03 08 15 16 17
19 35 36 37 46 47 55 56 57 58 75 76 77
Controlled composition: 1,9l R4 EDC
G000AG 1464
Workshop: WSC 02410
Determinations
were
made
on
intervention and patrol vehicles type VW
Transporter Syncro. The diagnose equipment
used was: ELM 327 Blue Tooth, VCDS 12.12,
and software Torque, Vital Scan, Vag-Com
ROJ 12.12.
3.1. Functional parameters
Group 001: Quantity Injection
882 /min Engine Speed (G28)
8.2 mg/race Quantity Injection
7.1*KW Injection Duration Magnetic
Valve
189
[7].
4. CONCLUSIONS
3.2. Diagnostic interpretation
Group 003
It can be seen the fault of the air
received by the engine. This is mainly due to
the peacemaker valve which does not come
back to the normal position after leaving the
circuit in order to open the admission circuit.
Group 004
Injection occurs immediately after
TDC and creates a mismatch between the
angle of camshaft timing that normally has a
value up to 1,5 KW. Situation occurs due to
the change of distribution or some operation
where the camshaft sprocket was at the
beginning.
Group 011
The lock of adequate pressure on the
blower at a small value creates a negative
deviation and it is caused by some air leakage
on the hoses path or connections, but it can
also be generated by the malfunction of the
turbocharger geometry.
Group 013
The injectors from the 1-st and/or 3-rd
cylinder work on unsuitable parameters. The
1-st injector shows a light un-calibration
distributing a larger amount of diesel fuel or it
compensates the 3-rd injector that seems to be
stifled.
Group 015
It can be noticed that although the
vehicle is running at idle and the consumption
190
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The rational use of fuels and the decreasing of IC (Internal Combustion) engines pollution are
fundamental requirements which were globally emphasized by the traffic authorities. As a transition
solution to the propulsion system which is nowadays named unconventional but, at the same time, as a
viable possibility to improve the IC engines performances of the future HVs (Hybrid Vehicles), some
researchers suggest the solution of Semy-Hybrid hydrogen fuelling system. This study is included in the
same activity area but it has to be mentioned that the researchers have begun from a different idea: the
hydrogen is not the real culprit for the positive results which were sometimes reported. The key of
problem is a substance which is fully presented but it was neglected by the majority: the nitrogen.
Keywords: Semy-Hybrid vehicle, nitrogen, nitro-hydrogen additivation, Pre-Combustion Treatment
Technology (PCTT)
1. INTRODUCTION
The rational use of fuels and the decreasing
of IC (Internal Combustion) engines pollution
are fundamental requirements which were
globally emphasized by the traffic authorities.
Due to these, the OEMs invest more and more
resources. The HVs (Hybrid Vehicles) and
first of all the EVs (Electric Vehicles) are
remarkable developing in the last years.
Unfortunately the global economic crisis
influenced this process negatively and partly
stopped it before some aspects (which had
decreased the costumers interests: the
acquisition price, the limited range, the
technological constructive difficulties etc.) to
be solved.
As a transition solution to the propulsion
system
which
is
nowadays
named
191
192
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Fuel(CnHm)
Reactants
Air(21%O2,79%N2)
HHOgas
Reaction/
combustion
chamber
Products
193
Preliminary results/conclusions:
The equipment based on the water
ionization/electrolysing in order to produce the
HHO gas and which has been made so far for
decreasing the fuel consumption and pollution
are not the final solution. The effects
sometimes positive are due to some
complicated chemical reactions which are
produced (or they should be produced) in the
combustion chamber as a result of captive fire
gases (which resulted from the former
194
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
195
4.
CONCLUSIONS: POSSIBILITIES
TO DEVELOPE THE ON-BOARD
HYDROGEN SUPPLY EQUIPMENT
TOGETHER WITH SOME ORIGINAL
AUXILIARY INSTALLATIONS
Briefly, the main developing directions for
this area are shown in Table 4.1.
The situations 2, 3, 4 and 8 are the current
on-board hydrogen supply equipment. In this
case A, B, E and G are obtained. The former
HHO supply plants are shown in 1, 3 and 8
cases. These had a lower efficiency to produce
hydrogen but they had high water volumes. In
these situations A, B, C, E, F and G can be
obtained. Nowadays, the situations 2, 3, 6 and
8 are tested. The water injection system
(situation 9) has good results and it can work
with the possibilities 2 ,3 and 6.
The hydrogen cannot be used as a simple
engine fuel only if it is in high volumes which
are impossible to be produced on-board.
Moreover, it is not more efficient than classic
hydrocarbons
(because
of
generation
difficulties) and it is very dangerous in
exploitation. It is unlikely for a distribution
network to be realised soon in order to solve
the problem of hydrogen economy.
As a final conclusion, the fundamental
paradigm (general conception) changing, the
use of nitrogen from the environment air, of
the water and some chemical substances cheap
and abundant as ingredients in the combustion
chamber in order to obtain explosive
substances could ensure a slower and more
efficient transition to electrical economy.
Table 4.1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Possibilities:
The water electrolysing with acid
electrolyte
The water electrolysing with alkaline
electrolyte
The combustion chamber residual EG
use
The EGR (if it exists) exhaust gas use
without bubbling
The EG use by building of EGR type
route without bubbling
Using of a bubbler for the recovered EG
The using of additives or fuel mixtures
or/and lube oil which could be nitrated
The water injection into combustion
chamber
The water and different additives
injection
REFERENCES
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
It could be obtained:
Ionized water
Oxygenated water
Nitrogen acids
Ammonia
Nitrogen salts
Hydrocarbon nitrates
Gas hydrogen, gas oxygen HHO (the
name adopted in this situation)
196
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract:.Oxidation of iron in oxygen is an important power source for cutting steel through thermal
processes.For oxygen-assisted laser cutting of steel plates energy to melt the material is given by the
oxidation reaction and the laser beam radiation.It provides a way to assess the contribution to material
melting of two physical phenomena.The material is removed in the molten state.On the basis of the cut
shape are calculated power consumed to start the oxidation reaction and power given by reaction.The
efficiency of the cutting process is expressed as dimensionless fractions.
Keywords: laser oxygen cutting,steel, specific energy.
1. INTRODUCTION
The cutting of materials by a thermal
process can be helped by the presence of
reactive gas which together with material
removal effect support a chemical exotherm
reaction which brings energy to the erosion
front [1],[2]. Using oxygen to cutting by
melting of iron base materials is due to a
favorable conjuncture of situations that make
this possible. Thus the combustion of iron
from steel in oxygen liberates sufficient
calories to compensate heat losses by
conduction, convection and radiation and
heated the reaction products so as to keep the
local temperature of workpiece to iron
ignition.
Temperature for ignition of the reaction should
be close to the melting temperature of the
metal. Also, the melting temperature of the
formed oxides` should be close to the melting
temperature of the metal so that all the reaction
products are liquid and can be removed by the
kinetic effect of the gas as they are formed.
At forming temperature oxides can be,
solid, liquid or gas. For solid oxides forms a
197
(8)
3. EXPERIMENTS
In experiments was used a CO2 laser
MAZAC 1500. Maximum average power
emitted is 1500 W. In experiments using
carbon steel sheet cold rolled SR EN 10025
(OL 37 - STAS 500/2, S235), with a thickness
of 3 mm [3], [4].
In the experiments have varied the following
parameters:
-Oxygen pressure pO2 [bar]. Oxygen pressure
is a process parameter that was measured at
the outlet of the gas tank. It has a direct
influence on the gas speed in the cut and as
result in chemical reaction of burning material.
- Average power P[W]. Average power is the
energy emitted by the laser oscillator in a long
time. Average power is directly adjustable on
the machine control.
- Cutting speed v [mm/min]. Cutting speed is
the relative speed of movement between the
laser head and the workpiece. Its influence is
considerable both in general cutting process
and particularly for irradiation conditions.
Cutting speed is adjustable directly on the
machine control.
- Pulse frequency f [Hz]. Pulse frequency is
the number of pulses per unit time. Pulse
frequency is adjustable directly on the machine
control.
- Cycle [%] cycle (or duty cycle) is the ratio
of pulse duration (or pulse time) and total
duration of the between two pulses (period).
Cycle is adjustable directly on a machine
command.
Upper and lower levels influence factors
are given in Table 1.Was measured cut width
on top of workpiece ws [mm] and bottom of
workpiece wi[mm]. The top piece is
considered that direct irradiated by laser beam.
In the calculations was used the average cut
width:
w + wi
wm = s
[mm]
(9)
2
Energy evaluation of laser cutting process was
done by identifying a type power size a
associated with physical phenomenon. Thus,
similar to the average power of the laser beam
material is considered power necessary to melt
the material a power consumed to start
oxidation reaction and power released as a
198
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
199
Where:
e sheet thickness, e= 3mm.
P
[J/mm](11)
- linear energy E l =
v
Specific energy to removing material
characterized cutting process relative to
change of influence factors. Although the
calculations are based on values for a cut
already achieved efficiency helps when you
want to determine the linear energy for other
processes of laser cutting. From the
technological point of view, it is intended
situation that the specific energyf or material
removal is to minimal value.
Minimum specific energy expressed as
minimum energy consumption as a quantity
expressed in J to remove the maximum of
material expressed in mm3.
The reduction in the values specific energy
may be associated with the oxidation reaction
contribution. The oxidation reaction increases
cut cros-section area through without changing
the linear energy.
Figure 1 shows the Pareto diagram for
specific energy Q. Decreased specific energy
Q means lower energy consumption to remove
unit volume of material. It is observed that the
higher effect is the speed, followed by the
power effect. Speed effect is a decreasing
effect and the power is increasing effect.
(14)
Af =
w wi 2
1 ws + wi
2
( s
) + e 2 [mm ] (15)
2
2
2
200
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
201
202
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
203
3.
204
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Oxygen assisted laser cutting is carried out by penetration of the material followed by
stabilizing and movement of the cutting front. Pulsed irradiation can be expressed as peak power and
ratio spot overlap indepndente sizes.Using a factorial experiment allowed the evaluation of the effects of
varied parameters on the cut width. It followed the correlation between varied parameters and physical
phenomena for laser cutting.
Keywords: laser oxygen cutting, pulse wave regime, spot overlap ratio, cut shape.
1. INTRODUCTION
The oxygen-assisted laser cutting is a
process having a complexity of the physical
phenomena that take place.
From the physical point of view the it is
noted study of individual physical phenomena
such as absorption of laser radiation, material
melting, oxidation reaction, heat losses by
conduction andgas dynamics to cutting front.
From the technological point of view it is
preferred approach as a model of type inputs
(influence factors or varied parameters) output (objective functions sizes directly
measured or calculated on the basis of
measurements).
There are important differences between the
two approaches. Physical exclusive approach
leads to detailed consideration of issues
ignoring the overall context, and technological
approach ignores the basic physical aspects
associated with the variation of parameters.
This paper proposes a rapprochement
between the two approaches. It will consider a
tiered approach to physical phenomena in laser
cutting process. This takes into account
205
[s]
(2)
f
Length of the interval between pulses
toff[s], is that time during laser oscillator does
not emit radiation. In relation (2) intervenes
coefficien (cycle or filling ratio for
irradiation), which can be calculated from the
relationship:
tp
(3)
=
= t p f [%]
t p + t off
where:
206
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1
[s]
(4)
f
For technological equipment used in
experiments directly adjusts cycle and
frequency, pulse duration is a derived quantity
from them. On the other technological systems
laser pulse duration is controlled directly.
Knowledge of two sizes in relations (2), (3) or
(4) defines the pulse irradiation regime used.
The average power P [W] is the power
emitted from laser oscillator in a long time and
is equivalent to the power emitted
continuously.
The peak power Pp[W] represents the
maximum laser power. To a rectangular pulse
shape peak power is related to the duration of
the pulse. The peak power is calculated based
on its relationship with average power.
P
[W]
(5)
Pp =
t p + t off =
207
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
209
210
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
211
212
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Nowadays the laser is used more and more in industrial application. This gains more and more
uses in wood industry. Operations which cannot makes with traditional technology can be made by laser
technology. This paper is a study about laser using in the wood industry. The paper is a synthesis about
scientific literature and papers from this domain. It shows an approach of the processing as wood cutting,
burning and engraving. This study brings together all processing parameters found in literature. Some
particular characteristics of the wood processing by laser are also presented. Advantages and
disadvantages of the laser working are presented, as well. The most used woody species are presented,
too.
Keywords: laser, wood processing, cutting, pyrography, engraving
1. INTRODUCTION
Wood processing by laser is less developed
than other similar areas. The laser machining
for metal working has developed enhanced
because of high power lasers which can cut
high density materials. High costs of
producing laser effect are offset by the reduced
costs due to premature wear of the tool.
In the medical field the laser has imposed,
because it has high accuracy than conventional
processes, but also due to the fact that the side
effects are greatly diminishes. Lasers have
very precise control of the working
parameters.
The advantages listed above do not have
shown interest in woodworking because this
material does not have a density comparable to
metals. The species with the highest density
wood is Lignum-vitae wood (Guajacum
officinale L.). The density of this is 1400kg/m3
213
214
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
215
216
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
5. CONCLUSIONS
Cutting
217
Laser
type
Power
Speed
Gas CO2,
He and
H2 [5]
Pyrography
Gas CO2,
He [4],
O2 and
N2 [3]
Engraving
Qswitched
diodepumped
frequencydoubled
Nd:YAG
[10]
106...109 W/cm2 [5]
91500 mm/min
50800
mm/min
Table2.Thewoodyspeciesandmaterials
processedbylasers,foundinliterature.
Cutting
Pyrography
Engraving
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
219
220
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper presents an original colour measuring method using an assembly consisting of a
computer system equipped with a scanner. One of the advantages of this method is that one it can
determine the colour on small surfaces just of 1x1pixels using a common equipment. This means that the
errors resulting when measuring the colour on larger surfaces (when actually an average colour of the
surface is assessed) are avoided. Transforming from RGB colour system to CIEL*a*b* system is also
presented. The CIEL*a*b* system was elected because it is the most widely used colour system. A
measuring example is presented.
Keywords: measuring, colour, wood, pyrography, Lazarus, Pascal.
1.
INTRODUCTION
portables.
Colorimeter is a device of fairly simple
design based upon the visual concepts of
colour. The sample is illuminated at a 45
angle relative to the perpendicular line to the
plane of the mounted sample. The method of
the trichromatic colorimeter allows for the
quick obtaining of the trichromatic
components X, Y and Z.
Spectrocolorimeters are somewhat of a
hybrid instrument which is capable of
providing colorimetric data such as X,Y,Z or
CIEL*a*b* values for various standard
illuminations.
Spectrophotometers provided wavelength
by wavelength measurement and data
collection at each 1nm or lower if is desired.
The spectral method of determining the
trichromatic components is based on the
spectrophotometric raise of the curve of
radiance spectral factors; this is a relatively
laborious method.
Micro-processors
are
capable
of
calculating colour differences, pass/fail, shade
sorting, whiteness, grades of fastness, and
many other shows of colour and appearance. A
colour is expressed through different
intensities of the system basic colours
depending on the chosen colorimetric system.
Many portables do not meet the same
performance specifications as bench-top
models in areas such as spectral resolution,
bandwidth, and large-to-small viewing areas.
The main disadvantage of the measuring
apparatus is that they do not have possibility to
modify measuring area.
It studied measuring wood colour by
means of the CorelDraw program [8]. This
method presents a disadvantage that read data
need transfer to other software for processing.
Another disadvantage is that the surfaces can
be only by 1x1pixels, 2x2pixels and 5x5pixels.
2. MEASURING
METHOD AND APPARATUS
222
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
(1)
hab= arctg (
b
)
*
a
(2)
The colour characterization by means of
the brightness (L*), the chrome (C*ab) and the
hue angle (hab) according to is shown in
Figure 1 [9] , in which the measured sample is
represented as A point of coordinates L*A; a*A,
b*A. The L*A, value (which is the brightness
of the respective sample) is on the L* axis at
the cross-section of this axis with the a*b*
plane where is A point.
The device used for the colour
measurement consisted of a PC-scanner-screen
assembly.
Before starting the measurements, this
assembly was calibrated so the values read by
the PC, for the R, G, B trichromatic
components, to be as close as possible to the
ones given by the colour specimen. The
assembly was calibrated with white standard
specimen. To this end, the colour specimen
have been scanned and the R, G, B values
were determined.
Calibration is made in computer software.
Measured values of the specimen are entered
as a correction factors in calibration group
box. These values are entered separately for
each parameter (R, G or B). This tool is shown
to Figure 3.
The images were scanned by means of a
Pentium 4 computer and a HP LaserJet 3055
all-in-one printer, fax, copier, scanner type.
223
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3. CONCLUSIONS
It is made measuring on some wood
samples. It can notice the measured values are
dispersed but still closed (especially for
CIEL*a*b* series). That means the
measurement accuracy is good.
In the most cases it is necessary to
measurement the colour difference of two or
more measurement in same place. For that it
needs to know the exact location of the
225
REFERENCES
1. Brenci, Luminia-Maria, Programarea
calculatoarelor i limbaje de programare n
industria lemnului - Statistic matematic
aplicat, internet i limbajul HTML. Braov:
Editura Universitii Transilvania (2010)
2. Laurenzi, W., Intoducere n programarea
vizual
n
Delphi.
Braov:
Editura
Universitii Transilvania (2012)
3. Lazarus, Homepage. [online]. Available:
http://www.lazarus.freepascal.org/ (January,
2014)
4. Lunguleasa, A., Stiinta lemnului. Braov:
Editura Universitii Transilvania (2001)
5. Millis, M. S., Understanding pyrography,
the photochemistry of scorched decoration.
Pro Ligno. Vol. 9 / No. 4 (2013)
6. Oxford dictionaries, Color: definition of
color in Oxford dictionary (American
English).
[online].
Available:
http://www.oxforddictionaries.com/us/definiti
on/american_english/color (March, 2014)
7. Popa, E. , Popa, V., Lemnul de anin, plop,
salcm. Proprieti, colorare (Alder, Poplar,
Robinia Wood. Properties, Coloration).
Braov: Editura Universitii Transilvania
(2004)
8. Popa, E. , Popa, V., Msurarea culorii
lemnului cu ajutorul programului CorelDraw /
Measuring Wood Color by Means of the
CorelDraw Program. Pro Ligno. Vol.4 / No. 2
(2008)
9.
STAS
6880/1-88,
Colorimetrie.
Colorimetrie de reflexie. Noiuni generale.,
Bucuresti: ASRO (1988)
10. , Parametri descriptivi. [online].
Available:
http://statisticasociala.tripod.com/parametri.ht
m
(February,
2014)
226
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. GENERAL CONSIDERATION
Titanium alloys with wide applications in
various fields, from manufacturing to
aviation,
electrotechnics,
electronics,
medicine, present multiple structural systems,
possibilities offered by their polymorphism.
Various structural compositions can be
obtained through heat and thermo chemical
treatment operations. In titanium alloys, there
are typically three types of layers, as in the TiAl system (figure 1).
Figure 1. The Ti-Al equilibrium diagram
[1]
227
Figure 2. The Ti-X equilibrium diagram for alphagene (a) and betagene (b) alloy elements
[2]
In addition, the alloying elements form, as range of values to the alloy in equilibrium or
it has been shown, defined TimXn type heat-treated, according to the quantitative ratio
compounds and out of balance phases (through of them.
thermal treatments) such as:
the phase: supersaturated in
1. EXPERIMENTAL TESTS
betagene elements solid solution with deformed
hexagonal lattice;
For the experimental tests, it has been
the phase: the martensitic solid chosen the Ti6Al4V titanium alloy, which can
solution with rhombic lattice;
be found in applications from many areas. The
the sem phase: supersaturated solid standardized
and
the
experimentally
solution;
determined
chemical
compositions
are
the phase: solid solution with provided in table 1.
hexagonal lattice.
Each of these phases, with their own
properties, imprints features included in a wide
Table 1. The chemical composition for Ti6Al4V titanium alloy
No.
1
2
Values
after
AS9100
ISO 14001
measured
Fe
Ti
Residual
elements
5,56,75
3,54,5
0,4
0,08
0,05
0,2
0,015
rest
0,4
6,23
4,14
0,2
0,02
0,02
0,19
0,003
rest
<0,4
228
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Delivery status
Hardening in the
furnace with
controlled atmosphere
Hardening in vacuum
3
4
5
6
7
Ti6Al4V
Hardening and
annealing
Hardening in vacuum
and annealing
Hardening, annealing
and nitriding
Hardening, annealing
and nitriding
1020
90
500
Hardness Resilience
[HRC]
KCU
[J / cm2]
42,56
55,30
53,46
36,58
56,56
37,17
60
nitrogen
ventilated
air
54,63
40,42
500
30
air
58,13
46,33
520
240
air
540
240
air
844,56
[HV 0,3]
881,06
[HV 0,3]
229
25
TAYLOR
HOBSON
PRECISION
component, to determine the profile of the
wear surface (figure 3).
a)
b)
Figure 3. The tribometer device to determinate the wear resistance:
a) the test facility; b) connecting the tribometer to a PC
The tests were carried out by pressing a
sphere with a diameter of 6 mm on the surface
of the sample, with a force of 10N, a linear
speed of 10cm/s and a stop after 5000 laps.
The wear rate is provided directly after
measuring the surface of the wear trace with
the help of the tribometer surface analyser, the
Kinds of
material
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Ti6Al4V
Delivery status
Hardening in the furnace
with controlled atmosphere
Hardening in vacuum
Hardening and annealing
Hardening in vacuum and
annealing
Hardening, annealing and
nitriding
Hardening, annealing and
nitriding
230
0,729
0,472
0,314
nitrogen
0,522
nitrogen
0,336
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Time [min]
5
10
15
20
25
30
35
Sample in
delivery
status
0,05553838
0,1319666
0,2070887
0,3082072
0,3866197
0,4385598
0,4730372
Sample hardened
from 850C,
annealed to
500C, 120 min
0,06000434
0,1824015
0,150185
0,1758861
0,2352871
0,2675284
0,3590557
2. CONCLUSION
REFERENCES
The
experimental
tests
have
demonstrated the capability of the titanium
alloys to respond to the heat treatments
through structural changes. This layout allows
modifications of certain mechanic features
depending on the necessities.
It has been proven that there is a
significant correlation among the structure, the
mechanic properties and the wear resistance.
Also, it has been demonstrated that
there are advantages of vacuum heat treatment,
especially after annealing, over the one in air
atmosphere or atmosphere controlled.
The
nitriding
thermo
chemical
treatment proved to be more effective at
540C, when the diffusing layer proved to be
more consistent.
232
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract : Upon Ti6Al4V titanium alloy there were effectuated different heat treatment operations. The
results obtained were tested by numerous processes such as optical microscopy, mechanical and
technological attempts, and also ESEM - Enviromental Scanning Electron Microscopy investigation and
X-ray analysis , respectively. The latter are the objectiv of this paper. Trough these observations there
has been highlighted a series of aspects regarding the composition and internal structure of the alloy in
different states obtained by heat treatment . There has been also establish the proportion between the
structural phases. These analyzes come to complete the data necessary for an accurate assessment of the
influence of thermal treatment concerning use characteristics. Thus, it can be chosen the structural state
according to practical necessites. There are presented in this paper, some of this investigations.
Keywords: titanium alloy, metallographic structure, hardening and tempering, ESEM- Enviromental
Scanning Electron Microscopy , X-ray spectra.
1. INTRODUCTION
Titanium alloys, they benefit from
numerous
advantages
concerning
the
properties, as compared with other metallic
materials, such as low density (about 4.5
g/cm3),
high
refractoriness,
corrosion
resistance, good weldability, mechanical
properties appreciable. Meanwhile, the two
allotropes Ti compact hexagonal lattice and
Ti with volume centered cubic lattice,
offers them application availability of many
heat treatment operations. [1, 3]. Among the
Fe
233
Ti
6,23
4,14
0,20
0,02
0,02
0,19
+"+
rest
iniial +
0,003
Hardness
[HRC]
42,56
53,46
54,63
Resilience
[KCU]
55,30
36,58
40,42
+TimXn+ [2]
234
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Element
Al
Ti
V
Total
Percent by
weight
Wt [%]
7.91
92.09
0
100
Figure 2. The X-ray emission spectrum of the compact phase. Ti6Al4V alloy. Delivery status.
.
235
Element
Al
Ti
V
Total
Percent by
weight
Wt [%]
6.92
89.82
3.25
100
236
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Element
Al
Ti
V
Total
Percent by
weight
Wt [%]
7.37
92.63
0.00
100
Figure 5. X-ray emission spectrum in the compact phase. Ti6Al4V alloy. Hardening in water
from 850 C.
Element
Al
Ti
V
Total
Percent by
weight
Wt [%]
6.94
90.97
2.09
100
Figure 6. X-ray emission spectrum in the acicular phase. Ti6Al4V alloy. Hardening in water
from 850 C.
The quantitatively report of constituents in was shown this heating , by its effects is an
this state is 38,6% compact phase and 61,4% aging ; more specifically this is an artificial
acicular phase : - for sample hardening from aging, which place the alloy in second
850 C and aging at 500 C. After hardening stadium of this process. During the heating
from 850C effectuated with a higher speed occurs an complete process of precipitation
in water, on some samples it has been of a secondary phaseTimXn .
applied a one hour reheating at 500 C. As
237
Figure 7. ESEM image of Ti6Al4V alloy, water hardened from 850 C and aged at 500 C.
Emission spectrum
phase found the presence
aluminum components
Emission spectrum of
of the compact
of titanium and
(see Figure 8).
the mechanical
Figure 8. Emission spectrum in the compact phase. Ti6Al4V alloy. Tempering and aging at
850 C to 500 C
Percent by
weight
Element
Wt [%]
AlK
7.06
TiK
88.12
VK
4.81
Total
100
Figure 9. Emission spectrum in the RX acicular phase . Ti6Al4V alloy. tempering and aging
at 850 C to 500 C.
In this case, the quantitatively report of
constituents is 65.5% compact phase and
34.5% acicular phase .
238
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
4. CONCLUSIONS
Thermal treatments aim to change some
physical-mechanical characteristics in order
to obtain the necessary properties for further
processing or use. These properties are
determined by the structural composition of
alloy and the quantitatively report of the
phases.
Experimental attempts of the present work
were able to produce significant changes in
the structural aspect of Ti6Al4V alloy,
supported also by mechanical properties
(density, resilience).
Through investigations effectuated
by
electron microscopy and X-ray it was
revealed internal structure of the alloy in
three different status, refering to the size and
shape of the grains, the nature of the phases
of the structure, their reciprocally
arrangement also quantitatively report of
phases.
All this is fully consistent both with the
sequence of thermal operations but also with
performed properties. Also, it is concluded
that in the case of the present alloys and
thermal parameters used, the heating
subsequently hardening could be enclose in
239
240
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Starting from the Toyota Research Group
first polymer-clay nanocomposite, the
improvement of properties of this new class of
materials intended for structural applications
was demonstrated. They rapidly enjoyed a
spectacular success in military and commercial
aircraft equipment, the automotive industry
and even sporting goods and health care
products.
Polymer-clay nanocomposites have been
considered as matrices for fiber-reinforced
composites for aerospace components, since
the aerospace industry requires lightweight
materials with high strength and stiffness,
among other qualities. These enhanced
polymer systems provide opportunities to
address material limitations in advanced
system concepts: impact resistance, control
241
242
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
243
Clay
PP
PP-Btn Bentonite
PP-MMTMontmorillonite
K10
PP-I.30P Nanomer I.30P
Clay
Composition, %
particle
PP
Clay
size, m
100
9-20
95
5
5-10
95
5
15-25
95
Young modulus
(MPa)
1512
2198
1159
2146
Yield strength
(MPa)
31.97
30.35
18.21
28.27
Elongation
at yield (%)
5.06
3.96
8.69
3.61
Tensile
strength (MPa)
26.11
27.83
18.00
26.43
Elongation
at break (%)
8.20
5.06
10.77
4.29
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
245
246
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
247
248
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
properties of particulatepolymer
composites. Composites: Part B. 39
(2008).
14. Ghugare, S.V., Govindaiah, P.,
Avadhani, C.V. Polypropylene-organoclay
nanocomposites
containing
nucleating agents. Polymer Bulletin. 63
(2009).
15. Bikiaris, D.N., Vassiliou, A., Pavlidou,
E., Karayannidis, G.P. Compatibilization of PP-g-MA copolymer on
iPP/SiO2 nanocomposites prepared by
melt mixing. European Polymer
Journal. 41 (2005).
16. Selver, E., Adanur, S. Processing and
property relationship of polypropylene
monofilaments containing nanoclay.
Journal of Industrial Textiles. 40
(2010).
17. Lazzeri,
A.,
Bucknall,
C.B.
Applications of a dilatational yielding
model to rubber-toughened polymers.
Polymer. 36 (1995).
18. Pukanszky, B. Particulate filled
polypropylene composites. In J.
Karger-Kocsis, Polypropylene: An A-Z
Reference,
Dordrecht:
Kluwer
Publishers (1999).
19. Fang, Z., Hu, Q. Influence of
interfacial adhesion on stress-strain
properties of highly filled polyethylene. Die Angewandte Makromolekulare Chemie. 265 (1999).
249
250
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The paper deals with an aircraft jet engine with cooling fluid injection in its compressor, meant
to temporarily increase its thrust, treated as controlled object. The author has established systems
motion equations, consecutive to the new gas-dynamic and fluid mechanics conditions. Using the
equation system, the author has obtained engines new structure matrix description, as well as its transfer
function. A study concerning its time behavior, for two different fluids, was eventually performed (about
its speed, combustor temperature and thrust) and some conclusions were presented. The paper is useful
for students and researchers in their jet engine automation studies and may be improved by considering
the flight regime influence, where possible.
Keywords: engine, control, cooling, injection, compressor, thrust augmentation, step response.
1. INTRODUCTION
One of the aircraft jet engines thrust
increasing methods consists of fluid injection
in the front of its compressor. The phenomena
are described in [3,4,5] and thermodynamically explained and grounded in [5].
From the practical point of view, the
aircraft engine may be overboosted using
afterburning systems or alternative thrust
augmentation methods. The afterburning is the
most efficient thrust augmentation method, but
in the same time, it is the most expensive-one,
because of its fuel consumption increasing, as
well as because of its mandatory constructive
modifications and automatic control schemes
implementation. Meanwhile, the afterburning
isnt an appropriate thrust augmentation
system for turboprop engines, nor for twin-jet
turbofan engines. Especially for turboprops,
the lack of air and the presence of the propeller
251
( )
i1* c
= i1*
k 1 a
c
k a 1
a 1
a
( )
1 , (1)
a
c
a 1
a 1
a
( )
i1
ai
c
ai 1 i
a 1
ai ai
1 =
ci i 1 , (4)
ai 1
k 1
ai 1
c k 1
ai 1 = i
1
qi (5)
c
( )
( )
( )
a 1
a 1 a
ai 1
. (6)
ci = 1 + i
c a 1
ai a 1
( )
k 1
k
( )
c
a 1 a
= i
c
ai a 1
a 1
a
( )
m& r f
1 + l
m& a i1
(7)
m& g T3
1.4
1.35
ma=10 kg/s
1.3
*c=6
1.25
1.2
1.15
1.1
1.05
.
ml
1
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8 [kg/s]
252
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
m& g T3
p3
m& a T3
CA p2
m& ai T3
CA p2i
(8)
1.3
1.25
Fi
F
1.15
(9)
(11)
cspi
csp
1.1
.
ml
.
ma
1.05
1
1.35
1.2
1.4
0.05
0.10
0.15
0.20
0.25
0.30
0.35
0.40
0
k 5n
k1T 3
k 2T 3
0
0
k1 p 2
k2 p2
1
k 4T 3
k5T 3
k3 p 2
k4 p2
k5 p 2
k 4T 4
0
k1 p 4
0
k3 p 4
k4 p4
0
T4*
p*2
p*4 ,
p2 0
p2 0
T3 0
m& ai
n = m& l ,
(18)
n 0
or
p20 m& gi
m& ai p2
0
( )
m&
CA ai
p
0
2
p2
p +
0 20
T30 m& g i T3
n0 m& ai
m& ai T3 T3
m& ai n
0
0
0
0
(m& l )0 m& l
m& l
=
= l
.
(m& l )0
m& ai (m& l )0
( )
( )
n =
0 0
( )0
(14)
bT = 0 0 0 0 k5QcQc .
(15)
The involved co-efficient are used with their
expressions, described in [8].
Based on previous chapters thermodynamic considerations, one can affirm that the
fluid injection has influence on the compressors characteristics, as well as on the air/gases
flow rate balance along the engine.
Consequently, one has to modify the equations
involving the compressors pressure ratio, the
pressure and temperature behind the
compressor, the temperature behind the
engines combustor, as well as the equation of
flow rates continuity.
One has to study two cases: a) neutral
( )
p3 + g i T3 = ai p2 +
p
p
T
2 0
3 0
3 0
m& ai
n + m& l .
+
(17)
(13)
u T = n T3*
(19)
X
X0
254
.
mc
.
ml
.
mc
n
T3*
Aircraft
jet engine
.
ml
a)
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
a1s+a0
u
1
ms+m
b1s+b0
b)
(21)
specific isobar heat of the
where c p g ,c pa
T
T
T2 = 2 c = 2 c p2 , (22)
p
c 0
c 0 2 0
T2
or as
p20 T2 c
= p2 .
T2 0 c 0 p2 0
(23)
b) If the in jected fluid is a combustibleone, the Eq. (21) must be entirely considered.
Consequently, the quantity m& l CA Pl adds a
new term to Eq. (25) and modifies the coefficient of m& c , so the right member of the
above-mentioned equation becomes
m&
m& c T T20
1 Pl l0 m& c l0 p 30
m& l =
Pc m& c
&
m
P
c
CA
c
0
0
/
/
= k5c m& c k5l m& l .
(27)
The fifth lines new form is
k 5 n n + k 5/ T 3 T 3 + k 5/ p 2 p 2 = k 5/ c m& c k 5/ l m& l
, (28)
so, the mathematical model should be
completed. If the second line is multiplied by
Considering Eqs. (16), (17), (18) and (23),
k5/l
one obtains from (24)
, then added to the fifth line, one obtains
l
m& c0 CA Pc
m& c0 CA Pc n 0
/ k5/l
/ k5/l
k2 n
+
+
+
k
n
k
k
5n
5T 3 T3 +
c p T3 T2 p2 m& c p m& a m& l
2T 3
l
a
0
0
0
0
0
l
&
&
m
P
m
P
c0 CA c
c0 CA c
p2 0
k/
& c .(29)
+ k 2/ p 2 5l + k5 p 2 p2 = k5/c m
l
&
m
l
0
m& l .
p20 2 c p2 = m& c
p
The [A]-matrix, as well as the (b)-vector
&
m
c0 CA Pc
c 0 2 0
should be modified in appropriate modes, with
(25) respect to the injected fluid nature.
One can observe that the co-efficient
5. SYSTEMS QUALITY
m& l0
m& c0 CA Pc
the same response of the combustor temperature parameter and figure 6 contains engines
thrust behavior for the same conditions.
The case of the injection of a neutral fluid
(pure water) into the compressor brings next
mathematical model modifications
1
n (s ) =
1.283 m& c 0.092m& l ,
1.6348 s + 4.5158
(0.089 s + 0.315)m& l ,
(35)
depicted with dash lines in figures 4, 5 and 6.
The case of the injection of a combustible
fluid (methanol) into the compressor brings
similar mathematical model modifications, as
follows
1
n (s ) =
1.43 m& c 0.184m& l ,
2.161s + 4.7973
parameter F .
One has chosen, for a quantitative study, a
VK-1A-type jet engine, with constant area
exhaust nozzle, having in mind only the engine
as possible controlled object, without its
control systems (without the speed controller
and the temperature limiter).
Output parameters expressions for the
VK-1A basic engine are
1.2606
(30)
n (s ) =
m& c ,
2.0859s + 5.1015
1.3799 s + 2.3888
(31)
T3 (s ) =
m& c ,
2.0859s + 5.1015
1.3762 s + 4.762
(32)
F (s ) =
m& c ,
2.0859s + 5.1015
depicted with continuous lines for step
responses in figures 4, 5 and 6.
Figure 4 shows the engines speed
parameters step response, while figure 5 shows
T3 (s ) =
(33)
1
(1.474 s + 2.748)m& c
1.6348 s + 4.5158
(0.047 s + 0.034)m& l ,
(34)
1
(1.385 s + 4.516 )m& c
F (s ) =
1.6348 s + 4.5158
T3 (s ) =
(36)
1
(1.816 s + 2.467 )m& c
2.161s + 4.7973
(0.053s + 0.047)m& l ,
(37)
1
(1.584 s + 6.317 )m& c
F (s ) =
2.161s + 4.7973
(0.113s + 0.803)m& l ,
(38)
depicted with dash-dot lines in figures 4, 5, 6.
0.35
injection of
neutral fluid
injection of
combustible fluid
0.3
0.25
0.2
basic engine
0.15
0.1
0.05
t [s]
0
256
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
T3*
0.9
0.8
0.8
injection of
neutral fluid
0.7
0.7
0.6
0.6
injection of
neutral fluid
0.5
0.5
0.4
injection of
combustible fluid
0.4
0.3
0.3
injection of
combustible fluid
basic engine
0.2
0.2
basic engine
0.1
0.1
0
t [s]
0
t [s]
0
0
6. CONCLUSIONS
258
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The paper deals with an aircraft jet engine with cooling fluid injection into the rear part of its
combustor, meant to temporarily increase its thrust, treated as controlled object. The author has
established systems motion equations, consecutive to the new gas-dynamic and fluid mechanics
conditions. Using the equation system, the author has obtained engines new structure matrix description,
as well as its transfer functions. A study concerning its time behavior was performed (about its speed,
combustor temperature and thrust) and some conclusions were presented, comparing to other cooling
fluid injection methods results. The paper is useful for students and researchers in their jet engine
automation studies and may be improved by considering the flight regime influence.
Keywords: engine, cooling fluid, injection, combustor, thrust augmentation, flow rate.
1. INTRODUCTION
One of the aircraft jet engines thrust
increasing methods consists of fluid injection
in the rear part of its combustor, in the mixing
area. The phenomena are described in [3,4,5]
and thermo-dynamically explained and
grounded in [5].
The aircraft engine may be overboosted
using afterburning systems or alternative thrust
augmentation methods. The afterburning is the
most efficient thrust augmentation method, but
in the same time, it is the most expensive-one,
because of its fuel consumption increasing, as
well as because of its mandatory constructive
modifications and automatic control schemes
implementation. Meanwhile, the afterburning
isnt an appropriate thrust augmentation
system for turboprop engines, nor for twin-jet
turbofan engines in their outer jet. Especially
259
mc
swirl
burning can
fuel injector
combustor
fuel
air
burned gases
air
mg
burned gases
air
cooling
fluid
ma
ml
Figure 1. Aircraft jet engines combustor with cooling fluid injection facility
2. THERMODYNAMIC EFFECTS OF
THE FLUID INJECTION
2.1 Flow rate balance. The fluid injection
brings into the combustor (and into the general
flow) an extra flow rate m& l .
Most of the nowadays operational jet
engines have critical flow in their turbines [5],
remains conp3
stant even if one uses the fluid injection, where
m& g is the burned gases flow rate, T3 gas
so the flow parameter
1.15
1.1
csp i
csp
1.05
1
m& g T3
temperature before the turbine, p3 gas pressure before the turbine, proportional to the air
pressure after the compressor p3 = CA p2 .
Fi
F
1.2
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
.
ml
.
ma
0.50
260
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
swirl
mc
burning can
fuel injector
combustor
fuel
ma
air
burned gases
air
burned gases
air
.
m
by-pass air
ap
mgp
cooling
fluid
exhaust
nozzle
air
ml
burned gases
fuel
Figure 3. Jet engines combustor with cooling fluid injection, air by-pass and supplementary combustor
supplementary combustor
(1)
(2)
g 2 g 1
,
cr
Rg g + 1
while for the engine with fluid injection
m& g = A3 /
m& gp = A3 /
cr
p3
T3
p3
T3
(3)
gp +1
gp 2 gp 1
,
Rgp gp + 1
(4)
/
where is the flow rate co-efficient, A3cr
turbines stator critical area, g , gp adiabatic exponents of the burned gases, Rg , Rgp
2 gp 1
1 ap (1 + l + c )
Rg gp + 1
=
,
g +1
(1 ci )
Rgp
2 g 1
g + 1
(5)
where c ,ci fuel flow rate fractions for the
basic engine, respectively for the engine with
cooling fluid injection (determined as
1
),
min L stoechiometric
c =
CAmin L
minimum air value for 1 kg of fuel, CA air
excess co-efficient in engines combustor,
ap extracted air flow fraction and
CA Pci + il
(11)
.
CAmin L
Eqs. (6) and (11) may determine the
extracted air fraction, with respect to the
injected cooling fluid fraction.
0
k 5n
1
k 4T 3
k5T 3
k3 p 2
k4 p2
k5 p 2
u = n
k1 p 2
k2 p2
k 4T 4
0
k1 p 4
0
k3 p 4
k4 p4
0
(13)
(14)
bT = 0 0 0 0 k5QcQc .
(15)
i2 + ci ( CA Pci + ic ) + l il = 1 ap + l + c i3i
0
0
p*4 ,
(9)
(10)
k1T 3
k 2T 3
T3*
T4*
p*2
262
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
( )
p3 + g i T3 = ai p2 +
p
p
T
2 0
3 0
3 0
m& ai
n + m& l .
+
(17)
n 0
T30 m& g i T3
n0 m& ai
m& ai T3 T3
m& ai n
0
0
0
0
(m& l )0 m& l
m& l
=
= l
.
(m& l )0
m& ai (m& l )0
( )
( )
n =
0 0
( )0
(19)
X
X0
(20)
(21)
specific isobar heat of the
m& g i
m& a
T3 sed with respect to p2
i CA i p2 +
p
T
p2 0
2 0
3 0
T
T
T2 = 2 c = 2 c p2 , (22)
p
m& ai
c 0
c 0 2 0
n = m& l ,
(18)
0
p2 0 T2 c
or as
T2 = p2 .
(23)
p
p20 m& gi
m& ai p2
T
2
c
2
0
0
0
or
CA +
m& ai p2
p
p
The
cooling
fluid,
which
is
injected
into
2
2
0
0
0
0
the rear part of the combustor is a neutral-one
and doesnt participate at the burning reaction
( )
263
.
mc
.
ml
.
mc
n
T3*
Aircraft
jet engine
a1s+a0
.
ml
b1s+b0
a)
ms+m
b)
m& c0 CA Pc n 0
m& c0 CA Pc
c p T3 T2 p2
0
0
0
+
&
m
P
c0 CA c
p m& P
c0 CA ci
2 0
meter F .
One has chosen, for a quantitative study, a
m& l0
2
c
VK-1A-type jet engine, with constant area
p20 p2 = m& c
m& l
p
&
m
P
c
CA
ci
exhaust nozzle, having in mind only the engine
c 0 2 0
0
(25) as possible controlled object, without its
One can observe that the co-efficient control systems (without the speed controller
and the temperature limiter). Its flight regime
m& l0
of the injected fluid flow rate is conventionally chosen as stationary
m& c0 CA Pci
(airspeed V=0) at sea level (altitude H=0).
Output parameters expressions for the
& l has a very small value comparing
parameter m
VK-1A basic engine are
to 1, the value of the co-efficient of m& c , so it
1.2606
(30)
n (s ) =
m& c ,
may be neglected. Consequently, the above2.0859s + 5.1015
determined equation may be re-written as
1.3799 s + 2.3888
/
/
(31)
(
)
s
T
=
m& c ,
3
k5n n + k5T 3T3 + k5 p 2 p2 = m& c
(26)
2.0859s + 5.1015
and the last line in matrix [A] should be
1.3762 s + 4.762
(32)
F (s ) =
m& c ,
appropriate restored.
2.0859s + 5.1015
The [A]-matrix, as well as the (b)-vector
should be modified in appropriate modes, with depicted with dashed lines for step responses
in figures 5, 6 and 7.
respect to the injected fluid nature.
Figure 5 shows the engines speed parameters step response, while figure 6 shows the
4. SYSTEMS QUALITY
same response of the combustor temperature
Jet engines behavior, as controlled object parameter and figure 7 contains engines thrust
(system), should be studied for the new behavior for the same conditions.
The case of the injection of a neutral
conditions. Systems quality consists of
engines step response (its time behavior for cooling fluid (water) into the rear part of the
engines combustor brings next mathematical
step input or inputs).
An aircraft engine with combustor fluid model modifications
1
injection can be represented, as controlled
n (s ) =
1.411 m& c 0.167 m& l ,
2.3761s + 4.817
object, by a system with two inputs (fuel flow
rate and injected fluid flow rate) and more
(33)
264
0.35
T3*
0.9
fluid injection into
the engine's compressor
0.3
0.8
0.7
0.25
0.6
0.2
0.5
0.4
0.15
basic
engine
0.1
0.3
0.2
0.05
t [s]
0
0.4
fluid injection into
the engine's combustor
0.3
0.2
0.1
t [s]
0
0
T3 (s ) =
1
(1.8732 s + 2.847)m& c
2.3761s + 4.817
&l
(0.0823 s + 0.0764)m
F(s ) =
(34)
1
(1.583 s + 5.167 )m& c
2.3761s + 4.817
&l
(0.0834 s + 0.4725)m
t [s]
0
0.5
0.1
0
basic
engine
(35)
In order to realize a comparison between the
performances of the fluid injection thrust
augmentation methods, the results of the
compressor fluid injection method in [10] were
taken and inserted into the diagrams in figures
5, 7 and 7 (dash-dot lines).
5. CONCLUSIONS
Cooling fluid injection into the jet engines
combustor determines gas-dynamic modifycations and performances improvement.
265
REFERENCES
1. Berbente, C., Constantinescu, N. V. Gases
Dynamics, vol. I, II. Politehnica University
in Bucharest Inprint (1985).
2. Hill, P. G., Peterson, C. Mechanics and
Thermodinamics of Propulsion. Addison Wesley Publications, New York (1993).
3. Ispas, St. The Turbo-Jet Engine. Technica
Publishing House (1985).
4. Mattingly, J. D. Elements of gas turbine
propulsion. McGraw-Hill, New York
(1996).
5. Pimsner, V. Air-breathing Jet Engines.
Processes and Characteristics, Bucharest,
Didactic and Pedagogic Publishing (1983).
6. Stoenciu, D. Aircraft Engine Automation.
Aircraft Engines as Controlled Objects.
Bucharest, Military Technical Academy
Inprint (1977).
7. Stoicescu, M., Rotaru, C. Turbo-Jet
Engines. Characteristics and Control
Methods. Bucharest, Military Technical
Academy Inprint (1999).
8. Tudosie, A. N. Aerospace Propulsion
Systems Automation. University of Craiova
Inprint (2005).
9. Tudosie, A. Aircraft Gas-Turbine Engines
Control Based on the Fuel Injection
Control. In Max Mulder Aeronautics and
astronautics. Intech Open Acces Publisher
(2011).
10. Tudosie, A. Mathematical Model For A Jet
Engine With Cooling Fluid Injection Into
Its Compressor. Proceedings of International Conference of Scientific Paper
Scientific Research and Education in
AirForce AFASES 2014.
266
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Fiber reinforced composites were primary developed for aerospace and defense applications.
High performance materials were designed and obtained exploiting the fibers high strength-to-weight
ratio. The well known complex textile structures used as reinforcements for advanced composites are 2D
and 3D woven fabrics and nonwoven fiber mats, but the knitted fabrics (weft knitted structures, as well as
warp knitted) are of high interest in last decades due to their properties and development potential. There
are three main types of 3D knitted structures: multiaxial fabrics (multilayer), knitted fabrics with spatial
geometry (spatial fashioned) and sandwich/spacer fabrics. Their characteristics and applications are
summarized herein.
Keywords: fiber reinforced composites, 3D knitted structures, aerospace applications
1. INTRODUCTION
The history of textiles can be traced back
to the prehistoric times. Current applications
of textiles have crossed many barriers and
reached limits beyond expectations. Fields like
sports and leisure, healthcare and wellness,
energy generation and storage, electronics and
IT, automotive and aerospace, just to give a
few examples, are using hi-tech textile
reinforced
composite
materials.
Fiber
reinforced composites were primary developed
for aerospace and defense applications. In
these
industries,
high
performance
considerations overbalance cost efficiency
criteria. High performance materials were,
therefore, designed and obtained exploiting the
fibers high strength-to-weight ratio. Textile
reinforced composites proved to be
267
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Fiber
Carbon
Boron
E-glass
S-glass
Kevlar 29
Kevlar 49
Relative
density
(g/cm3)
2.0
2.6
2.5
2.6
1.44
1.45
Young`s
modulus
(GPa)
400
400
70
84
60
60
Tensile
strength
(GPa)
2.0-2.5
3.4
1.5-2.0
4.6
2.7
2.7
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
271
3. CONCLUSION
By
combining
textile
processing
techniques
with
advanced
materials
characterization methods and prediction
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
http://www.intechopen.com/books/advance
s-in-composite-materials-ecodesignandanalysis/development-of-3d-knittedfabrics-for-advanced-composite-materials
(January 2014).
Hu, J. Introduction to three-dimensional
fibrous assemblies. In J. Hu, 3-D fibrous
assemblies Properties, applications and
modelling of three-dimensional textile
structures,
Cambridge:
Woodhead
Publishing (2008).
Fukuta, K., Onooka, R., Aoki, E.,
Nagatsuka, Y. In S. Kawabata, 15th Textile
Research Symposium. Osaka: The Textile
Machinery Society of Japan (1984).
Scardino, F. An introduction to textile
structures and their behaviour. In T.W.
Chou, F.K. Ko, Textile Structural
Composites, Composite Materials Series,
vol. 3. Amsterdam: Elsevier Science
Publishers B.V. (1989).
Lau, K.W., Dias, T. Knittability of High
Modulus
Yarns.
In
M.L.
Scott,
th
Proceedings of the 11 International
Conference on Composite Materials (6
volumes) JTI. Cambridge: Woodhead
Publishing (1994).
Savci, S., Curiskis, J.I., Pailthorpe, M.T.
Knittability of Glass Fiber Weft Knitted
273
274
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: During recent decades the stirring up of the processes of globalization, practically in all
spheres of present day civilization, has aggravated and brought numerous problems resulting from
nature-society interactions. To overcome these problems, it is necessary to develop and adopt new
concepts and techniques to study and evaluate the changes occurring on the earth ecosystem. For this,
application of information technology via Environmental Information Systems is the best option. Much
more, understanding this complexity through interactive applications will develop new strategies and
ideas to manage and protect ecosystem. This paper deals with new and interactive approach to process,
analysis and synthesis of environmental systems using various models and IT applications, so we could
underline that environmental science and technology are therefore a vital component of productive
knowledge and thus a high priority for the mankind sustainable fraternity with nature. Since years,
environmental scientists and computer experts are working on different and innovative computer-based
modeling techniques to study the environmental problematic and hazards system and to provide the
maximum accuracy in decision making or in elaborating sustainable strategies of community
development. This kind of innovative techniques, some of them exemplified in the present paper
(GeoGebra, AutoCAD, G.S. Surfer, ArcView GIS etc), can become the answer to question in those cases
where the early warning, maximum accuracy in prediction and emergency is taken in account.
Keywords: Environmental Informatics, IT applications, innovative
1. INTRODUCTION
The modern society (information society)
in accordance with the actual changes and
preocupations in the environment domain has
provided various types of informatics
resources (tools, methodologies, procedures)
to manage and support the ideas and actions
related to the environmental issues.
Population grows over time as well as the
modern technology implication in everyday
life. Informatics become essential for all the
275
2. ENVIRONMENTAL INFORMATICS
METHODS AND TECHNIQUES
Nowadays, significant efforts are required
to analyze relevant data and environment
information, simulate related processes,
evaluate resulting impacts or scenarios and
generate viable decision alternatives.
The informatics resources developed in the
last 3-4 decades have enabled and help us to
investigate the complex interactions between
the natural systems and engineered ecosystem,
and also to search for sustainable strategies for
a harmonious development.
In figure 1 are mentioned the general steps
necessary to define, analyse and solve the
problems related to obtaining environmental
information with help of EISs.
276
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
277
3. CONCLUSIONS
Information
and
communications
technologies have produced unprecedented
changes in society in all its aspects.
Nowadays,
Artificial
Intelligence
via
interactive computational applications plays a
specific and well defined role in all areas or
activity
domains:
production,
service,
management, monitoring, research, public
involvement in decision making, and in almost
all countries.
Environmental systems are based on the
above considerations binding instruments in
environmental science, can be defined as a
collection of packet data and information,
described by a series of specific indicators
relevant for studying, monitoring and
exhaustive exploration of the field and
environmental issues.
As a conclusion, it can be said that modern
data analysis methods are useful tools in
environmental informatics and environmental
statistics. Good methods are understandable
for the environmental scientists and at the
same time reliable, robust and helpful for
discovering important relationships in the data.
In cooperation between environmental
scientists and information scientists, what
makes the relationship flourish is the
278
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: App Inventor for the Android platform is a powerful visual and drag-and-drop tool that lets
anyone build and design games and other mobile apps with 2D graphics and animation, create
multimedia quizzes and guides, design complex apps that control robots, apps that inform and educate or
learn computer sciences - with no programming experience required. App Inventor is freely available for
anyone to use, runs online and is accessible from any browser, so the users can design the app interface
using a web-based graphical user interface builder only by piecing together blocks like in a puzzle.
In this paperwork we try to give some basic ideas of how everyone using App Inventor could build a
specific mathematic application similar to Microsoft Mathematics v. 4.0 - a very powerful software that
provides a set of mathematical tools that help students get school work done quickly and easily.
Keywords: Environmental Informatics, IT applications, innovative
1. INTRODUCTION
People have been doing personal
computing since the 1980s, but todays mobile
applications are making computing personal as
never before [3]. Today, we carry computers
with us constantly, as smart-phones and pads
and the new devices that are regularly
emerging.
More significantly, todays personal
computing is increasingly about us: where we
live, where we work, who our friends are,
what we buy, what we like, whom we talk
with, and what we talk about. This personal
computing is linked to global data services and
information sources in a way that
fundamentally transforms our experience and
our perception of our world.
279
Fig. 3. The development process of every apps clarifying the Design Idea
280
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
281
4. CONCLUSIONS
Information and communications tools and
methodologies have produced unprecedented
changes in our society in all its aspects, but
especially in mobile devices environment.
According to this trend, in the present
workpaper, we try to help everyone who use
App Inventor for Android and are interested in
mathematics to develop specific educational
applications.
REFERENCES
1. Burnette E., Hello Android: introducing
Google mobile development platform, The
Pragmatic Bookshelf, USA, 2010
2. Kirk A., Data Visualization: a successful
design process, Packt Publishing Ltd., UK,
2012
3. Kloss, Jorg H., Android Apps with App
Inventor: the fast and easy way to build
android apps, Pearson Education Inc.,
USA, 2012
4. Marinacci J., Building Mobile Applications
with Java, O'Reilly Media Inc., Canada,
2012
5. Mednieks Z., Dornin L., Nakamura M.,
Programming Android, O'Reilly Media
Inc., Canada, 2011
6. Segaran T., Beautiful Data - the stories
behind elegant data solutions, O'Reilly
Media Inc., Canada, 2009
7. Steele
J.,
Iliinsky
N.,
Beautiful
Visualization - looking at data through the
eyes of experts, O'Reilly Media Inc.,
Canada, 2010
8. Svirin A., 1300 Math Formulas, The
Pragmatic Bookshelf, USA, 2004
9. Tyler J., App Inventor for Android: build
your own apps - no experience required!,
John Wiley Ltd., USA, 2011
10.
Wolber D., Abelson H., Spertus E.,
Looney L., App Inventor - create your own
Android apps, O'Reilly Media, Inc.,
Canada, 2011
11.
http://appinventor.mit.edu
12.
www.appinventor.org
13.
www.it-ebooks.info
282
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Energy is the important element that ensures the economic and social development level in the
world. According to the research made in this field a lot of researches are orientated to the development
of the alternative source of energy. The importance to ensure the necessary energy will be observed from
the moment when will start to exhaust the fossil combustible. This paper describes the efficiency use of
the fossil combustible and renewable source of energy (SRE) on Romanian energetically market. The
accessibility of the renewable energy source in the world directed the economical and social increase in
the developing state. Energy is a source that generates the progress of the state. The main objectives of
the paper are the accessibility of the energetically source in Romania and the fuel consumption for
heating. Important obtained results in the research describes the biomass (pellets, briquettes and wood)
as an accessibility solid combustible for producing energy in the world, being widely spread and the
cheapest on the energetically market.
Keywords: biomass, combustible produce, energy, fuels, heat
1. INTRODUCTION
In present all researches in Romania and
Europe try to exploit the alternative field in
energy production and bringing a lot of new
scientifically date about the renewable source
of energy, especially about the production of
energy from the biomass. Energy represents an
important point for all the developing
countries because energy offers comfort on
social and economical plan.
In this moment, main energetically source
are the fossil fuels like oil, coal, natural gas,
nuclear energy and a low percent from the
SRE (Source of Renewable Energy)
contributes in European Union (EU) with
about 10% to the energy production in 2010.
According to statistics, the field of the energy
production from fossil combustible will touch
the peak point in 2020, after which the chart of
283
Species
Willow
Beech
Spruce
Poplar
Ash
Beech
Willow
Spruce
Straw
Beech
Willow
Pit coal
Natural
gas
Table 1.
Chemical characteristics of the solid fuels
Energetically characteristic, %
C
H
O
N
A
Firewood
51.7 6.1 41.1 0.9
0.48
49.9 8.2 37.1 0.7
0.5
49.1 9.2 38.9 0.6
0.32
49.1 9.2 38.9 0.6
0.32
50.7 8.0 37.5 0.6
0.51
Briquettes
50.2 8.1 37.1 0.7
0.41
51.8 6.1 41.1 0.9
0.72
49.9 8.2 38.1 0.6
0.5
45.6 5.8 42.4 0.5
5.7
Pellets
50.2 8.1 37.1 0.6
0.5
51.7 6.1 41.1 0.9
0.48
Fossils combustible
65.9 4.6 23.0 0.7
1.2
75
25
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
285
The
moisture
content
used
for
determination was 20% for wood and 10% for
pellets and briquettes. The moisture degree in
the material is an important element from
which depends the amount of heat released in
a burning process. These are the limit of the
moisture contents for the sold combustible
materials by the suppliers. The calorific power
resulted in the experimental research (Figure 1
and 2) are determinate for moisture content of
20% for wood samples and 10% for briquettes
and pellets samples. An analysis of the
received results shows that the briquettes and
pellets have a higher calorific power in
compare with the wood sample. The pellets
have calorific power about
18,299 kJ/kg
(4.685 kWh/kg) and briquettes about 16,868
kJ/kg (4.227 kWh/kg) at the moisture content
of 10%. The compare fossil combustibles have
a LCP of 35,500 kJ/m3 (9.861 kWh/m3) for gas
and 29,000 kJ/kg (8.055 kWh/kg) for pit coal.
Figure 2.
Lower calorific power of the briquettes and pellets,
kJ/kg
Beech
Willow
Pit coal
Natural
gas
286
Burning time,
min
Energy density,
kJ/cm3
Beech
Willow
Spruce
Straw
Firewood
0.639 0.75
28
0.683 0.81
25
0.546 0.77
28
0.539 0.69
29
0.618 0.85
31
Briquettes
0.634 0.54
25
0.645 0.65
29
0.681 0.78
27
0.632 0.72
27
Pellets
0.560 0.45
26
0.580 0.56
28
Fossil combustible
1.0
1.30
42
1.0
0.717 38
Burning rate,
kJ/min
Willow
Beech
Spruce
Poplar
Ash
Density, g/cm3
Figure 1.
Lower calorific power of wood species, kJ/kg
Mass, g
Species
Table 2.
Energetically characteristics of the solid fuel
0.351
0.392
0.308
0.285
0.303
11.56
11.63
11.78
10.55
12.91
0.428
0.374
0.435
0.362
9.11
10.94
13.47
11.14
0.398
0.419
8.32
10.41
0.692
0.921
37.83
25.09
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Firewood
Briquette
Pellet
Coal
Gas
0.04
0.2
0.2
0.1
0.3
Price /kWh
0.009
0.04
0.01
0.01
0.03
108
324
287
4700
2700
955
Maintenance
costs, /year
Current
repairs, /year
955
108
1800
0.3
432
1800
0.5
97.2
4700
0.98
Total costs,
10800
1000
Energy
consumption,
kWh/year
Annual cost
for energy,
/year
2700
Gas
1.1
Coal
1.2
Unit price,
/kg; /m3
Cost thermal
furnace,
Pellets
18.2
Briquettes
Firewood
100
Heat
necessary, kW
Surface, mp
Table 3.
The account of the necessary of the heat and
consumption of the combustible
Consumption of: kg/h
Table 4.
Cost of the solid combustible in Romania
1000
Combustible
110
110
110
110
40
45
45
45
45
25
288
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
289
290
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The paper presents some aspects referring to water absorbtion and thickness swelling for solid
wood and chipboard (with and without melamine film for protection). There is made a comparison
between the two wooden materials in terms of hygroscopicity. A similar methodology was used in order
to obtain all results in the same conditions. Also, it was taken into account that wood has a different
swelling in tangential and radial direction and in the case of film covered chipboard the large swelling
was near the cuts and very small to the center of the specimen. Results have showed that swelling of
covered chipboard was lower than on solid wood.
Keywords: higroscopicity, chipboard, composite, solid wood, swelling
1. INTRODUCTION
Hygroscopicity of solid wood and other
wooden products as chipboard is an important
property because in the range of saturation
moisture content the dimensional changes
(swelling and shrinkage) are produced.
Beyond of certain limit of moisture content
(fiber saturation point, FSP) and certain time
the woody semi-product will be destroyed.
When water mass that is absorbed in woody
products will be reported to its initial mass the
phenomenon can be name the water absorption
and is specific for wooden panels as
chipboard, fiberboard, plywood, laminated
wood and so on. The same term is for solid
wood [1, 2, 3]. Consequently, the water
absorption, specific for both solid wood and
boards, is calculated with the next relationship
(Eq. 1):
mi m f
(1)
100 [%]
Aw =
mi
Fig 1. Form and dimensions of woody samples: afor solid wood; b-for chipboards; R-radial; Tgtangential; t-thickness of panel boards
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Table 1
Hygroscopical results for solid wood
tt =
tr =
t ft t it
t it
t fr t ir
t ir
N Mass, g
mi
mf
32,6
33,3
32,4
32,9
32,8
32,9
31,6
32,3
30,2
30,9
Mean
100
[%]
(3)
100
[%]
Thickness,
mm
ri/rf
ti/tf
tr
tt
Aw,
%
, %
19,7
20,0
19,8
20,1
19,9
20,1
19,8
20,1
19,7
19,9
1.
5
1.
5
1.
0
1.
5
1.
0
2.
4
2.
4
2.
3
2.
3
2.
4
2.4
1.95
4.6
1.95
3.3
1.65
2.2
1.94
2.3
1.70
2.5
1.83
20,4
20,9
20,4
20,9
20,4
20,9
20,4
20,9
20,9
21.8
tr + tt
2
(4)
N
o
1
2
3
4
5
No. Assortments
1
2
3
293
Table 2
Hygroscopical results for composites
t,
Mass, g
Thickness, mm Aw,
%
%
mf
ti
tf
mi
32.2 62.2 17.3 22.2
93.1 28.3
32.3 62.0 17.2 22.4
91.9 30.2
32.3 62.8 17.4 22.4
94.4 28.7
32.4 63.0 17.4 22.2
94.4 27.5
34.1 64.3 17.2 21.8
88.5 26.7
---------------92.4 28.2
Solid wood
Melamine
chipboard
Chipboard
Aw,
%
2.5
9.1
t %
1.8
(1.0+3.7)/2=2.3
92.4
28.2
melamine-coated
chipboards are superior
even than solid wood.
Additionally, in the paper, several
measurements were made on water absorption
and thickness swelling of wood-plastic
composite. The results (water absorption of
0.3% and 0.2% thickness swelling) showed
that this compound is different from the other
two materials taken into consideration in the
paper. There are no terms of comparison
between these types of materials related
higroscopicity.
4. CONCLUSION
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
295
296
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
It capitalized on the technical product
concept again, which is materialized as a
prototype.
Verifying a technical product is used in
consumer testing. Determined the essential
characteristics of the new product, prepare
samples produced in small quantities to
consumers targeted testing to obtain feedback
from them.
Constructive and technical refinement
phase, the development of product and
production process, is developed the new
product execution documentation: technical
specifications, drawings, formulas, patterns
and instructions. The new product is
experienced pilot or test stations, depending on
the nature of the product.[1]
.
Sales market are experimental tests
performed to determine product acceptance by
customers.
Thus the new product is launched into
production on a calendar scheduling appropriate
marketing.
297
2. ANALYSES
One of the essential foundations for
creating a successful new product over the
long term is to identify technological trends
from an early stage and to exploit the
opportunities that new technologies offer for
product innovations.
However, factors such as the hugely
dynamic nature of technological progress
make it increasingly difficult for the new
product
to
comprehensively
identify
technology-related opportunities and to
harness them in a goal-oriented manner.
A key prerequisite for successful
technology development therefore lies in the
ability of an organization to rapidly and
efficiently align the requirements of the market
with the potential offered by new technologies
and to integrate the results in its own products
and processes.
A fundamental contribution to the
development and design of technical products
were teachers and Wolfgang Gerhard Pahl
Beitz, whose book serves worldwide as basic
manual for students and researchers. In their
Marketclient
(socioeconomic
requirements)
Harnessing
innovative
ideas for new
technical
product
The idea of
new product /
new product
development
/ Year
Environment;
resource
protection
298
Activities
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Production
Planning /
new
technical
product /
Marketing
- Industrial
research
(applied)
- Development concepts,
studies, methods,
procedures, technical and
- Experimental economic analyzes, plans,
Development / diagrams, documents on
Technology
products and technologies.
- Technology
Transfer
- Recovery
results
- Design, implementation,
testing prototype / prototype
plant pilot.Validation / pilot
plant.
Market /
Marketing
Research /
Finding
innovative
ideas
The idea of
product /
Prototype /
Industrial
Design /
Simulation
299
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
300
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
301
2. ANALYSES
Learning
about
management
concepts
Information about
flexible
manufactur
ing system
Wisdom
Management
concepts
Expe-rience
in economic
field
Theory
regarding
quality
management
Information
product
flexible
manufacturing
system.
Product
manufacturing
information.
Operation
information in
flexible
manufacturing
system.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
303
Information
Knowledge
Formalise knowledge in
order to utilize in future
flexible manufacturing
system development.
3. CONCLUSIONS &
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
In this paper has developed a knowledgebased management in flexible manufacturing
system that adapts knowledge management
concepts into product development where the
major objectives were to provide decision
support to help economic field, according the
utilisation of best-know knowledge, minimise
costs, achieve quality assurance and shorten
time to product. Product development
activities must be structured in such a way that
any engineering decisions taken are based on
proven knowledge and experience. Any failure
to apply knowledge and experience could
result in product and process redesign, which
would be seen as non-value process and waste
of valuable resource. There is a need for a
knowledge-based framework to support
flexible manufacturing system development,
which includes a knowledge-based system
developed from an organisations knowledge
and past experience captured in a database.
This process involves the identification,
capture, formalisation and presentation of
knowledge and its utilisation to support
effective decision making within a product
development environment.
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
This paper is supported by the Sectoral
Operational Programme Human Resources
Development (SOP HRD), financed from the
European Social Fund and by the Romanian
Government under the contract number
POSDRU/ID134378.
REFERENCES
1
Chike, F., O., Alan, H., Knowledge
management to support product development
in cold roll-forming environment, 2011.
2
Polanyi, M., The tacit dimension.
Routledge and Kegan Paul, London , 1996.
3
Mohrman,
SA.,
Finegold,
D.,
Mohrman, AM., An empirical model of the
organization knowledge system in new product
development firms. J Eng Technol. Manag
20(12):738, 2003.
4
Ahna, JH., Chang, SG., Assessing the
contribution of knowledge to business
performance: the KP3 methodology. Decis
Support Syst 36(2004):4034162007, 2004.
304
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
This study represents a national and
international
concern
about
quality
management for companies. For this, an
analysis was made using the QFD method for
the company S.C. BETA S.R.L., where the
following six basic steps were emphasized:
identifying customers needs, identifying
technical needs, the relationship between
customers needs and technical needs,
competitive assessment and sales key points,
assessment of the technical needs of
competing product and services, setting targets
and selecting the technical needs that are to be
modified in the process.
2. QFD METHODOLOGY
QFD concept is a methodology for
systematizing the information obtained from
the user in order to get / to define the
characteristics of the product / service, market
adaptation.
QFD objectives provide information on
aspects of the product / improvement service.
305
ANALYSIS AND
IMPROVEMENT
Establish
the policy
and
objectives
Providing
resources
and
organization
SMC
planning
Relatio
nship
with
custom
ers
Provi
ding
servic
es
Servi
ces
after
delive
ry
Tracking
customer
satisfactio
Complain
ts
handling
Domestic
suppliers
SUPPLY
External
suppliers
306
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Delays;
Economic indicators.
Translations
Interpretations
Tutoring
INPUTS
ACTIVITY
OUTPUTS
Marketing
study;
- Rebates;
-Offers for
customers;
- Taking
orders
(works)
from
customer;
- Translatin
g works;
- Correctio
n;
- Deliverin
g works;
- Made by
telephone, at
the request
of customers;
- Choosing
the translator
for the
required
language;
- Documents
are
interpreted;
- Payment is
made by the
customer.
- Deliveri
ng
works;
- Promoti
on;
- Participa
tion to
national
fairs.
-Offers to
existing
customers
and
potential
customers.
-Through
advertisin
g.
Individually/
in groups;
-At the office
or address of
the customer.
Addressing
customer
requiremen
ts by the
company.
-Certificate
of
linguistic
competence
Identification;
Translation;
Requirements definition;
Drafting contracts;
Settlement;
Satisfaction assessment.
Proper analysis:
The analysis begins by studying the
process - customer relationship.
Currently the company does not have
documents showing irregularities concerning
time-limits.
Reasons for not complying with deadlines
are related to following aspects:
The big volume of work;
Incorrect communication of the
real time to the customer;
Stress at work;
Emergencies.
All these irregularities are due to company
policy "no work is refused, emergencies are
not a problem." Responsible for all these is the
general manager.
The aim is to avoid delaying the works as
regards the time agreed with the customer. For
this it was proposed to apply the method
"Demings Wheel" as follows:
Registrations
1. PLAN
3. ACT
2. DO
4.CHECK
Deviations
The main deviation in this company is the
lack of effective communication. The message
is often distorted due to the fact that messages
are not transmitted properly.
308
Respect the
time allocated
to each
department;
Consider a
higher period
of time for the
works that are
not "urgent";
"Emergencies"
remain a
priority;
Record orders
in the database;
2. DO
Interior
regulations
on
departments
Incentives/
penalties;
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
4. CHECK
3. ACT
Application of
internal order
regulations on
Departments.
9 Incentives:
Bonus by the
end of the
month;
Team-building;
Flexible
schedule.
Evaluation
of actual
results;
Comparing
these results
with the
targets set
in previous
planning.
9 Punishment:
Overtime;
Compliance
with the time
allocated to
each
department;
Record orders
in the database;
"Emergencies"
remained a
priority.
309
CS
MC
4
SC
C
EN
IMS
3
Company
interests
MC
SC
EN
IMS
IIT
MPC
PC
26
23 17 19
20
21
14
Requirements
LP
Q
STW
TOTAL
3. CONCLUSIONS
IIT
IMPROVING
CS
310
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Before being marketed, any product has been conceived, designed, manufactured, based on
schemes, drawings protected against internal and external theft of intellectual copyright or by documents
/ certificates / patents. After being marketed, the product becomes the source for copying, denigration etc.
All these actions are risk sources. Risk management helps us identify, analyze and treat the specific risks
of intellectual property. To overcome these specific risks of intellectual property it is necessary and
obligatory to make an analysis of the types of risks within industrial profile companies in order to
minimize the possible disastrous effects in research and production activities.
Keywords: creation, product risk, protection, analysis, identification, minimization.
1. INTRODUCTION
In accordance with ISO / IEC Guide
73:2002, risk can be defined as the
combination of the probability of an event to
happen and its consequences. [3]
In the industrial profile companies in all
types of activities, there are events and
consequences that could generate opportunities
for gain or threats leading to loss.
Although in most cases are taken into
account only the negative consequences of
risk, risk management includes both positive
and negative aspects of risk, and methods of
prevention and reduction of its effects.
Adverse effects of the different types of
intellectual property risks in the industrial
profile companies can be disastrous, but the
application of an efficient risk management,
aims to identifying factors that could affect the
proper functioning of the organization.
311
(1)
R=FxC
(2)
Or
Where:
P Is the probability of a negative event to
happen.
C - Is the consequence of occurrence of
that event.
H
G
A
RISKFACTORS
OFIP
B
C
F
E
312
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Setting
Goals
Risk
assessment
Risk
response
Monitoring
Information and
Communication
Risk
identificatio
Control of
activities
313
PERIOD OF PAID
PROTECTION
PERIOD OF UNPAID
PROTECTION
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
315
316
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper presents an original approach regarding the application of sweep to rotating blade
cascades. The justification for swept blades is given by its consequence, i.e. a reduction of local velocity
(usually from supersonic/ transonic to subsonic regimes) such that the losses due to shock waves and/or
boundary layer displacement and/or followed by reattachment are minimized. As study cases were
considered a cascade blade, as well as forward and backward sweep of span-wise cross sections. The
RANS model was used to describe the flow and a comparative study was conducted by using four
turbulence models, i.e. Spalart-Allmaras, k-, k- and Reynolds Stress RST models. The CFD analysis
was done with the FLUENT solver, with the settings for 2D case, implicit equations and double precision.
The convergence was monitored such that the residuals should be minimized. The results of the numerical
simulations of the flow are expressed as the distributions of Mach number (in relative flow, since it is a
rotational frame), static pressure, static temperature and entropy, which have been presented
comparatively, for each turbulence model and sweep study case, corresponding to the design rotational
speed of 275 [m/s].
Keywords: aerodynamics, rotating axial blade cascades, sweep, numerical simulation, CFD analysis.
MSC2010: _________
1. INTRODUCTION
The design of the modern aircraft
engines is targeted to the achievement of
new standards for performance and
reliability, as well as the satisfying of the
environmental friendly demands, i.e. tough
limitsforaircraftnoiseandemissionslevel.
Among the assets of the propulsion
technology that produce a quieter engine
are the advanced aerodynamics together
withcompositefans.Highspeedflowattip
blade, in particular for large diameter fans,
is responsible for noise and blade loss
induced by the occurrence of shock waves,
317
stall),withthedecayoftheflowcoefficient
at offdesign regimes, the tip blade area
(wherein the boundary layer has been
detached) becomes larger. The use of 3D
stacking has been the source of a large
number of experimental and numerical
investigations over recent years, and
consequentlyitcameuptheneedtodefine
carefully the conventions. Considering an
axis placed on the LE/ TE lines, Zerolift
airfoil axis or any other particular shape
and airfoil movement, can generate the 3D
stacking. In Fig. 1 are explained the sweep
anddihedralmovements.
Both the dihedral & sweep have been
introducedandusedfortherotor3Dblade
design into the core compressors for the
RollsRoyce Trent family engines and Joint
Engine Alliance of the GE & PW for the
GP7000series.
According to Gallimore [9-10],
Neubert and Weingold [13], Golub, Rawls and
Russell [11], theory would suggest that the
reduction in shock losses would be achieved
by either positive or negative sweep, but tests
of various transonic rotors demonstrate the
advantage of positive sweep in achieving both
improved efficiency and flow range.
(a)- sweep
(b)- dihedral
Fig. 1- Basic stacking line modifications, [5]
318
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
(c)- combination of
(d)- combination of
FWD & BCK sweep
FWD & BCK sweep
Fig. 2- Constructions of swept blades, [1]
B
Bottom
0
0
0
0
BM
5
-5
5
6
M
Midspan
7
-7
2
3
MV
V
Top
5
-5
-7
-6
0
0
-18
-3
3. MATHEMATICAL SUPPORT
3.1 Flow model
The Reynolds Averaged Navier-Stokes RANS
equations system (1) has been used for
modeling the main flow.
319
U
t F Q
(1)
T
t G S
t
V V pI
F
(4)
HV t T V
The source vector Q (5):
0
Q f
fV qv
The source term S (6):
S
S k
S
The viscous flux G (7):
t
k
kV
t
k
k
k
(5)
replacesthemolecularviscosity .
2
t 2 t d t VI
3
ef t
(a)- Spalart-Allmaras
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(b)-
(d)- RST
(c)Fig. 4 Mach number of the relative flow,
320
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
/ Spalart-Allmaras,
,
and RST
turbulence models/ no sweep effects
(a)- Spalart-Allmaras
,
and RST
/ Spalart-Allmaras,
turbulence models/ no sweep effects
(a)- Spalart-Allmaras
(b)-
(d)- RST
Fig. 5 Entropy distributions,
/ Spalart-Allmaras,
,
and RST
turbulence models/ no sweep effects
(c)-
(d)- RST
(c)Fig. 7 Temperature distributions,
/ Spalart-Allmaras,
,
and RST
turbulence models/ no sweep effects
For the study case, the results obtained by
using the Spalart-Allmaras SA turbulence
model are in accordance with experimental
data; the highest percent of recommendations
that can be found in literature [14-32] points
out that for the flow in (axial) cascades the
Spalart-Allmaras model is the best option to
describe the turbulence.
Table 2 The number of iterations necessary
for obtaining the convergence
Turbulence
model
S-A
RST
(a)- Spalart-Allmaras
(b)-
Number of iterations
Forward
Backward
No-sweep
sweep
sweep
3160
2781
4072
2923
2348
4255
5115
5172
4020
3308
2339
4972
(b)-
(d)- RST
(c)Fig. 6 Pressure distributions,
321
322
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
323
8.
(***),
Applied
Computational
Aerodynamics, vol. 125, Progress in
Astronautics and Aeronautics, editor
Henne P. A., John Wiley & sons, (1990).
9. Gallimore Simon J., Bolger John J.,
Cumpsty Nicholas A., Taylor Mark J.,
Wright Peter I., Place James M. M., The
Use of Sweep and Dihedral in Multistage
Axial Flow Compressor Blading Part I:
University
Research
and
Methods
Development, Jl. of Turbomachinery,
October (2002), vol. 124, pp. 521-532.
10. Gallimore Simon J., Bolger John J.,
Cumpsty Nicholas A., Taylor Mark J.,
Wright Peter I., Place James M. M., The
Use of Sweep and Dihedral in Multistage
Axial Flow Compressor Blading Part II:
Low and High-Speed Designs and Test
Verification, Jl. of Turbomachinery,
October (2002), vol. 124, pp. 533-541.
11. Golub A. R., Rawls J. W., Russell J. W.,
Evaluation of the Advanced Subsonic
Technology Program Noise Reduction
Benefits, TM-212144, (2005).
12. Gostelow J. P., Cascade Aerodynamics,
Pergamon Press, New York, NY, (1984).
13. Neubert R. J., Hobbs D. E., Weingold H.
D., Application of Sweep to Improve the
Efficiency of a Transonic Fan Part I:
Design, Journal of Power and Propulsion,
vol. 11, nr. 1, January-February, (1995),
pp. 49-54.
14. Adamczyk John J., Aerodynamic Analysis
of Multistage Turbomachinery Flows in
Support of Aerodynamic Design, ASME
Journal of Turbomachinery, April (2000),
vol. 122, pp. 189-217.
15. Anton Weber, Heinz-Adolf Schreiber,
Reinhold Fuchs, Wolfgang Steinert, 3-D
Transonic Flow in a Compressor Cascade
With Shock-Induced Corner Stall, Jl. of
324
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract. A new linear positive operator is defined and studied resorting to the method of
Mastroianni 2 , 3.
2000 Mathematics Subject Classification: 41A36, 41A25
Key words: Mastroianni operator, Szasz Mirakjan operator, approximation properties.
(iii).
1. Introduction
n ,c x
that 1
k
(iv).
n ,c nN
x 0,
x 0,
n ,c
c
x nc ln
n ,c x ,
1 c
(v). lim x
r
n ,c
is completely monotone, so
k
n ,c
x 0,
r N0 .
defined on 0, +) as
Let
c
n ,c x
1 c
ncx
, c 0, x 0, n N
n ,c 0 1,
E2 0, : f C 0,
Ln ,c : E2 0, C 0, as
n ,c C 0, ,
325
f x
1 x2
be the space endowed with the norm
f x
f sup
,
x
0
which is a Banach
2
1 x
space.
lim
Ln,c
f ; x pn,k ,c x f
k
with
n
k 0
(1.1)
k
1 x nc ln
k
k
n ,c x
1 x n ,c x
1 c
pn , k ,c x
.(1.2)
k!
k!
k
Because
k
ncx ln
c
1 c
p
x
x
n ,c x exp ncx ln
(
)
n , k ,c
n ,c
1,
k!
1 c
k 0
k 0
2. Main results
are given as
Ln ,c e0 ; x 1,
Ln ,c e1 ; x
Ln ,c e2 ; x
n , c 0
n
n ,c 0
n
e1 x cx ln
e2 x
c
,
1 c
n , c 0
n
(2.1)
e1 x x 2 c 2 ln 2
of 0, for any f E2 0, .
Indeed,
taking
c
x
c
c ln
.
1 c n
1 c
Remark.
converge
operators
If c the
to
classical
Sn f ; x e
k 0
c c n , n
compact subsets of 0, .
326
nx
nx
operators (1.1)
Szasz-Mirakjan
k
f , x 0 .
k!
n
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Ln ,c f ; x f x 1 1 Ln ,c
e xe ; x f , , x 0
2
with
Ln ,c e1 xe0 ; x x 2 (1 2
2
n 0
n 0
n 0
x
n
n
n2
c
c
c
c
) x ln
.
x 2 (1 2c ln
c 2 ln 2
n 1 c
1 c
1 c
c
c
nc ln
ncx
nxc ln
1 c c
1 c
p
x
dx
dx
0 n,k
0
k!
k!
1 c
c
0 x 1 c
k
ncx
dx
k
ncx
nc ln
1 k ! c
1
1 c
dx
k
c
k!
c 0 1 c
nc ln
nc ln
1 c
1 c
The Durrmeyer type operator asociated with the operator (1.1)-(1.2) become:
DLn ,c f ; x nc ln
pn ,k ,c x pn ,k ,c t f t dt .
1 c k 0
0
For these operators we have
327
DLn , c e0 ; x 1,
k
nct ln
n ,c t
c
1 c
DLn , c e1 ; x nc ln
t dt
pn ,k x
1 c k 0
k!
0
c
nc ln
c
1 c
p
x
nc ln
n ,k
1 c k 0
k!
n ,c t dt
k 1
nc ln
k 1!
c
1 c
p
x
nc ln
n ,k
k 2
1 c k 0
k!
nc ln
1 c
nc ln
1 c
k 1
p x
n ,k
c
c
nc ln
nc ln
1 c
1 c
1
1
1
x
nLn ,c e1 ; x
.
c
c
c
nc ln
nc ln
nc ln
1 c
1 c
1 c
k 0
k 1 p x
n , k ,c
k 0
nct ln
n ,c t
c
1 c
DLn , c e2 ; x nc ln
p
x
t 2 dt
n ,k
k!
1 c k 0
nc ln
c
1 c
nc ln
pn ,k x
k!
1 c k 0
k 2
n ,c t dt
nc ln
k 2 ! nc ln c
c
c
1
p
x
nc ln
n,k
k 3
k!
1 c k 0
1 c
nc
ln
1 c
1
2
k 1 k 2 p x
c k 0
nc ln
c
1
4x
2
x2
.
2
c
c
nc ln
1 c nc ln 1 c
n , k ,c
p x
k 0
n,k
k 2 k 1
nc ln
1 c
n L e ; x 3nL e ; x 2
2
nc ln
c
1
n ,c
n ,c
References
If c c n , n then
lim DLn , c n f f , f E2 0,
n
0, .
328
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
329
330
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: In this paper we study the propagation of the symmetric Lamb waves and we find the
equation of dispersion and the equations of the displacement vector in the symmetric case.
Keywords: 35L05, 35L10, 35P30.
1. INTRODUCTION
3. PROBLEM SOLUTION
331
(1)
tan qh
4k 2 pq
,
2
tan ph
q2 k 2
(3)
0 x2 eit kx ,
1
(4)
0 j x2 eit kx , j 1, 2,3.
1
The equation of
following relation:
dispersion
tan qh
4k 2 pq
2
tan ph
q2 k 2
with 0 and
has
the
2
vL2
k ,
2
q
2
2
vT2
k ,
2
(6)
cos qh
2k 2
cos
u1 qA cos qx2 2
px
2
k q 2 cos ph
cos t kx1 ,
2 pq cos qh
sin
u2 kA sin qx2 2
px
2
k q 2 cos ph
sin t kx1 .
(8)
. We
vL
vT
have p an imaginar number, i.e. p ip and q
a real number, so the dispersion equation has
the form:
The second case is for
tan qh
4k 2 pq
,
tan ph q 2 k 2 2
(5)
(7)
(9)
2k 2 cos qh
u1 qA cos qx2 2
cosh px2
2
k q cosh ph
cos t kx1 ,
2 pq cos qh
u2 kA sin qx2 2
sinh px2
2
k q cosh ph
sin t kx1 .
(10)
tan qh
4k 2 pq
tan ph q 2 k 2 2
. We have p and
vL
q real numbers, so the dispersion equation is
k . We have
v L vT
p and q imaginare numbers, i.e. p ip and
q iq , so the dispersion equation is
(11)
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
u1 qA cosh qx2
cosh qh
2k 2
2
2
k q cosh ph
2 pq cosh qh
k 2 q 2 cosh ph
(12)
where A is a constant factor.
3. CONCLUSIONS
REFERENCES
333
334
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Randomness is an essential resource for cryptography and random number generators
are, at the same time, very important for the most cryptographic systems. Using these weak random
values may lead to vulnerabilities of the systems, causing the adversary to easily break the system, as
demonstrated by breaking the implementation of Secure Socket Layer.
This paper presents a hybrid Secure Socket Layer that includes together a Quantum Random
Number Generator (QRNG), to generate the random numbers, and, an Elliptical Curve Cryptography
(ECC) algorithm, to encrypt the data.
Keywords: asymmetric cryptosystems, quantum random numbers, Secure Socket Layer.
MSC2010: 81P45, 94A15.
1. INTRODUCTION
Secure Socket Layer uses a combination of
public key and symmetric-key encryption.
Symmetric-key encryption is much faster than
public-key
encryption,
but
public-key
encryption provides better authentication
techniques.
The Secure Socket Layer handshake
allows the server to authenticate itself to the
client using public-key techniques, then allows
the client and the server to cooperate in the
creation of symmetric keys used for rapid
encryption, decryption, and tamper detection
during the session that follows.
In our paper, we present a theoretical
demonstration of how to improve the security
of Secure Socket Layer protocol by replacing
Random Number Generator with Quantum
Random Number Generator and the Rivest,
Shamir, Adleman (RSA) cryptographic
335
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1
part of random numbers are used to obtain
Master Secret
3
Encryption Keys
337
338
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
339
340
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper presents a new distribution wich unitary treated through the family of the power
series distributions, resulting in a new distribution which we called a Max Pareto power series
(MaxParPS) distribution. Some properties and reliability characteristics (e.g. survival function, hazard
rate) are studied. It also shows that in some conditions a Poisson limit theorem for this type of
distribution takes place.
Keywords: distribution of the maximum, limit theorem, Pareto distribution, power series distribution.
MSC2010: 60K10, 62N05.
1. INTRODUCTION
Together the most common reliability
distributions (exponential, Erlang, Weibull),
there was also Pareto distribution which has
applications not only in the economy (e.g.
income of the population), but also to the
study of lifetime of the systems k of n , as well
as in field of quality assurance [5].
Pareto at the end XIXth century, formulated
the principle of 80/20, of the unbalanced
distributions, which postulates that 80% of the
effects are generated by 20% of the cases.
This is the reason for introducing this new
class of MaxParPS distribution with the aim of
study the probability behavior of the most
complicated processes.
The methodology and techniques of
working are presented and analyzed in [2],
which allows the study of the distribution of
the maximum of a random sample of size Z of
the statistical population that has Pareto
341
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
A
x
,
(2.2)
u Par ( x)
x 1 A( )
for any x .
Also,
we
note
by
U Par maxX 1 , X 2 ,..., X N , where the r.v.
N PSD , [1,2].
probability
density
f X i ( x) f Par ( x)
x 1
function
, x.
Proposition 2.1.
If
r.v.
U Par maxX 1 , X 2 ,..., X N , where X i i 1
are i.i.d.r.v., X i ~ Par ( , ) , , 0 and
with
N PSD ,
a n n
, n 1,2,..., (0, ), 0 ,
P ( N n)
A( )
r.v. X i i 1 and N being independent, then the
d.f. of the r.v. U Par is given by:
A
x
U Par ( x)
, x .
(2.1)
A( )
We note that r.v. U Par following the
MaxParPS distribution of parameters , and
by U Par ~ MaxParPS ( , , ) .
A( ) A
x
SU Par ( x)
, x .
A( )
342
A
x
, x .
x 1 A( ) A
x
P ( N n)
sequence
A( )
a n n
, n 1,2,..., a n n1
a
A( )
of nonnegative real number,
an n ,
(0, ), 0 , then:
n1
where k min n N , a n 0 .
Proof: By applying the lHospital rule k time, we have:
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
A
x
0
0
...
lim
( k )
1 A
x
x
A( k ) ( )
1 k !a
k
x
k!ak
n1
1 , x .
x
th
Consequence 2.3. The
r
moments,
r N,
r 1
of
the
r.v.
U Par ~ MaxParPS ( , , ) is the following:
r
EU Par
, (2.3)
a n n
E maxX 1 , X 2 ,..., X N r
n1 A( )
where p.d.f. of the r.v. maxX 1 , X 2 ,..., X N is
given
by
n 1
f maxX 1 , X 2 ,..., X N ( x) zf Par ( x)FPar ( x) .
Proof: It is known that the distribution
function of the maximum of a sample of size
N n which has the d.f. FPar is
U n ( x) FPar ( x) n .
With total probability formula, a d.f. of the
maximum of a sequence of i.i.d.r.v. in a
random number, has the expression:
U Par ( x) U n ( x) P( N n)
n1
n
FPar ( x) P( N n)
, namely:
1 p
n
1 p (1 p ) n
x
U ParB ( x)
, (2.5)
1 (1 p ) n
for any x .
the
n1
343
where
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
U ParB ~ MaxParB( , , n, p ) ,
, 0 ,
n 1,2,..., and p (0,1) .
P.d.f. of the r.v. U ParB is defined
according to the relationship (2.2), so that :
n 1
np 1 p
u ParB ( x)
x 1 1 (1 p ) n
(2.6)
for any x .
At the same time, the
MaxParP
distribution is characterized by the d.f. defined
by
the
relationship
(2.1),
where
N ~ Poisson * ( ) PSD, 0
and
A( ) e 1 , with :
U ParP ( x)
1 e
, x .
(2.7)
, x .
(2.8)
n
p 0
n
p 0
pn
lim 1 p e
n
x
p 0
lim p n
n
x
p 0
e x
lim U ParB ( x)
n
p 0
x 1 1 e
lim (1 p ) n lim (1 p ) 1 / p
u ParP ( x)
e x
and
e x
n
p 0
then:
344
1 p (1 p) n
x
lim
n
1 (1 p ) n
p 0
e x
1 e
U ParP ( x), x .
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
REFERENCES
Probability density
1 0.04
MaxParB 1 1 20 x
2
MaxParP( 1 1 10 x)
0.02
10
20
30
40
50
345
346
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Nowadays, authenticated access to web sites becomes more and more important. Usernames
and passwords are one of the easiest ways to accomplish it. But a more secure approach is to use
biometrics. This article presents a very simple modality to use fingerprints to control the access to a web
site. The client component of the proposed architecture is an ActiveX control that communicates with the
fingerprint reader and sends data back to the web server. The server component is an ISAPI Server that
processes the requests of the client regarding authentication and does or does not grant access to the web
site. The ActiveX is integrated in the web page with the help of Java Script.
Keywords: web site authentication, biometrics, fingerprint
1. INTRODUCTION
Since its creation, Word Wide Web
(WWW) has continued to grow and to impact
the everyday life of people ([1]). News, mail,
banking, storage, and so on, are all provided as
web services through some web sites. But such
important services can be used with
confidence only if they also provide the
necessary security. The five most important
security
objectives
are
authentication,
confidentiality, integrity, non-repudiation, and
availability. For the web servers and for the
communication between the client applications
and the web servers, all these objectives (web
server
authentication
by
the
user,
confidentiality and integrity of the exchanged
data, availability of the server) were addressed
and accomplished mainly by using Public Key
Infrastructure (PKI) and cryptographic
operations through protocols like TLS
(Trusted Layer Security) or SSL (Secure
347
348
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
349
if(x==0)
// forbid access to site
}
2.3 The server component.
The server
side component was build using ISAPI Server
technology (Internet Server Application
Programming Interface). The communication
between
the
two
components
was
implemented
using
CGatwayInterface
implementation of the WinInet API provided in
350
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
351
2.
3.
4.
5.
Tim
Berners-Lee,
Information
Management: A Proposal, CERN, 1989,
[online].
Available:
http://info.cern.ch/Proposal.html (February
2014).
The Transport Layer Security (TLS)
Protocol Version 1.2 RFC 5246, [online].
Available:
http://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc5246/
(February 2014).
BIO-Key, WEB-KEY, [online]. Available:
http://www.biokey.com/products/overview-2/web-key
(February 2014).
Plurilock Security Solutions Inc.,
FINGERPASS,
[online].
Available:
http://plurilock.com/products/fingerpass
(February 2014).
DigitalPersona,
DIGITALPERSONA
ONLINE,
[online].
Available:
http://www.digitalpersona.com/Authenticat
ion-Solutions/DigitalPersonaOnline/DigitalPersona-Online/ (February
2014).
352
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Since the invention of public key cryptographic algorithms, researchers have also proposed
what will later be known as identity based cryptography: the use of identities as public keys. Over the
years, different identity based encryption and signature algorithms were developed, making possible what
others only predicted some 30 years ago. This paper is a survey over what identity based cryptography is,
what advantages it has over classical PKI, what success stories of its use already exists, and on how can
one benefit from it, in different civilian and even military scenarios. The purpose of the paper is to set a
background for latter research on developing an identity base cryptographic scheme for military use.
Keywords: identity based encryption, identity based cryptography, public key cryptography
1. INTRODUCTION
Identity-based cryptography is a particular
case of public key cryptography that in certain
conditions
offers
implementation
and
utilization advantages, without reducing the
security degree. In a conventional public key
security scheme, the generation of the two
keys (the private key and the public key) starts
from an unpredictable randomly chose large
number. This leads to two random keys
mathematically bounded. Given the random
character of the public key, it cannot be given
as is to the interested users because it would be
very difficult to store and to use. That is why
the certificates are use to bind the key to the
user and to the issuing certification authority.
The necessity of the certificates determines,
prior to any communication, the need to search
for the qualified certificate of the person
someone would like to securely communicate
353
354
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
355
356
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
357
358
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
359
360
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper focuses on the study of the asymptotic behavior of the medium number of
comparisons from the merging algorithm on two sorted arrays, depending on the total length of the
resulting array obtained by merging. This paper presents a program written in C++ that supports the
theoretical result that was obtained.
Keywords: arrays, data analysis, merging, sorting.
MSC2010: 26A03, 26A06.
1. INTRODUCTION
361
x1 x2 xn . In order to compute C , we
have to follow the next steps:
1. It is assumed that xi is the greatest
V x1 , x3
with
x1 x3 ,
V x2 , x3 with x2 x3 , V x1 , x2 , x3 with
362
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
i 2i 1
(1)
i 1
2i 1 2n1 1
(2)
i 1
i 2i 1
(3)
2n 2
(10)
2n 2
From the equality:
2n 2
(11)
0
lim n
n 2 2
results that for values of n big enough, C can
be approximate with n 2 .
The above chart of the function
2 x 2
,x0,
x 1
and
y ( x) x
2 2
1
proves that the approximation is
y (1)
ln 2
very good for values of n 10 .
C n2
i 1
4.5
2i 1 2n1 1
(4)
3.5
x
i 1
y=(2*x-2)/(2 -2)
n 1
n 1
2 i 2i 1 i 2i
i 1
(5)
(6)
x n 1 1
1 x x x
(7)
x 1
which occurs for x 1 , through derivation, and
then multiplication with x and substitution of x
with 2 we have the following equality:
2
n 1
i 2i n 2 2 n 2
2
1.5
1
0.5
i 1
2 2n 1 1 2n 2
3
2.5
(8)
i 1
10
Ox
15
20
This
theoretical
result
can
be
experimentally checked with the following C++
program :
#include <stdio.h>
#include <conio.h>
#include <malloc.h>
#include <math.h>
#include <stdlib.h>
int * aloc(int n)
{
int *p;
p=(int *)malloc(n*sizeof(int));
return p;
}
void sort_ascending(int *v,int n)
{
int i,j,temp;
for(i=0;i<n;i++)
for(j=i+1;j<n;j++){
if(v[i]>v[j]){
temp=v[i];
v[i]=v[j];
v[j]=temp;
}}}
void gen(int *v,int n)
{
int i;
for(i=0;i<n;i++)
v[i]=rand();
}
int interclas(int *v,int *w,int *x,int p,int q)
{
int i,j,k,ncomp;
ncomp=i=j=k=0;
while(i<p && j<q){
ncomp++;
if (v[i]<w[j])
x[k++]=v[i++];
else
x[k++]=w[j++];
}
while (i<p)
x[k++]=v[i++];
while (j<q)
x[k++]=w[j++];
return ncomp;
}
int main()
{
int p,q,*V,*W,*X,nc;
printf(" Size of V = ");
scanf("%d",&p);
printf(" Size of W = ");
scanf("%d",&q);
V=aloc(p);
W=aloc(q);
X=aloc(p+q);
gen(V,p);
gen(W,q);
sort_ascending(V,p);
sort_ascending(W,q);
nc=interclas(V,W,X,p,q);
printf(" C = %d\n",nc);
getch();}
The input of the program are: size p and
of the arrays
W w1, w2 ,, wq
V v1, v2 , , v p
and
1.
364
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
365
2. ROBOT AS A FRIEND?
In our days the robots are common, there are
presents I almost every industry and also in
almost every daily activities. Robots were
tools to do some task that were hard for the
men to do it, to reduce the time in productions
processes and to do some works in dangerous
environment. But, in the last years robots has
been introduce not only as a tool to do hard
jobs, but also as a tool to interact, collaborate
and assist humans been. The main idea was
and is in this days is create a robot able to
communicate and interact with people until
specific task has been accomplish.
A robot that is able to interact with humans
been is define as a Social Robot. To talk
about social robot is necessary to include some
concepts such as: embodiment, social
environment, and the capacity to reach it social
goals [2]. A robot can be social depending on
366
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
367
5. CONCLUSIONS
A social robot with an orientated skills
and behaviors can be useful in attentional
therapies with children in school age. The
child imagination allows establishing a
friendship between the robot, and the child and
this help in the therapy because the confidence
is gained and makes easier the interactions and
the reach of the task.
The robot will assist the psychology work,
and will guide the task of the child with
friendly dialogs, facial and body gestures.
This research is the beginning of the
project that has the collaboration of a primary
school, where the attentional capacities of the
children will be test and them an attentional
therapies will be accomplish in order to
measure the level of improve in each child.
REFERENCES
6. Bartneck, Ch., Forlizzi, J. A DesignCentred Framework for Social HumanRobot Interaction. Proceedings of the RoMan2004. Issue (2004).
7. Duffy, B. Anthropomorphism and the
social robot. Robotics and Autonomous
Systems 42. Issue (2003).
8. Mori, M. The Uncanny Valley. Energy.
Issue (1970).
9. Epley, N., Waytz, A., Cacioppo, J. On
Seeing Human: A Three-Factor Theory of
Anthropomorphism. Psychological
Review. Issue (2007).
10. Luria, A. Atencin y memoria. Barcelona:
Kairos (1984).
11. De la Barra, F., Toledo, V., Rodrguez, J.
Estudio de salud mental en dos cohortes
de nios escolares de Santiago Occidente.
368
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
MANAGEMENT
Continuous Improvement
Customer
Focus
Principles
Process
Improvement
Total
Involvement
Leadership
Education and
Supportive structure
Training
Rewards and
Communications
recognition
Elements
Quality
assurance
Quality
control
Inspection
370
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
MANAGEMENT
C.
D.
E.
F.
political criteria
in a very big
extent
too aggressive competition for high
scores between students
equally
school directors and inspectors not
so interested in co-operation and
having the common goals related
ensuring the quality in schools
in a small extent
evaluation
not
carried
out
considering
the
performance
standards known by students
in a small extent
not a direct connection between
success in school and success in
in a big extent
372
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
373
MANAGEMENT
374
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
* Academy of Economic Studies, Bucharest, Romania, ** Rocredit Broker, Baia Mare, Romania
Abstract: Present paper aims to highlight the evolution of damage into the Romanian insurance
market between 2007 and 2013. Damage is the unfavorable final result insurer which is part of an
insurance contract.
By analyzing claims rate for the Romanian insurance market in the period to which we refer
have found that the percentage of car damages were between 81 and 89% of the total general insurance
compensations paid. In comparison to the amount of insurance underwritten premiums, we found that for
some insurance classes the damage value is greater than the value of subscriptions. The vehicle damages
decreased the insurance market profits that where brought by other classes.
1. INTRODUCTION
The Insurance contract may have as a
finality to pay higher or lower damages
depending on insured amount and on the size
of the damage. On the insurance market
damages are compensation or indemnity paid
for loss suffered as a result of an injury or
breach of an contract or of a legal duties
committed by another person. The damage
produced by same cause must be compensated
only once. The size of the damage vary
between different classes. The nominal
375
MANAGEMENT
376
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3. LIFE INSURANCES
As it was observed from the Romanian
insurance markets evolution in the analyzed
period, life insurance is not a strong point for the
Romanian financial market. Throughout 20072013 this element did not exceed 10% of the total
market.
Regarding the life insurance claims rate it
is known to be low. This fact allows to the life
insurance companies to capitalize more and more
in time. The ransom of life insurance policies
before the term is penalized with substantial
reduction from the insurance allowance.
Most life insurance payments and
redemption redraw, where made before the term,
during 2007 2013 had a minimum ranged
between 11.76% in 2008 and a maximum value of
16.63%, in , 2012. Their evolution, in figures is
presented in Table 3.
4. CONCLUSIONS
In other EU countries insurers are using
outsourcing services for claims regulation like
independent evaluators.In Romania the insurer has
the monopole and entirely decision for damages
made on MTPL insurance policies. On voluntary
insurance policies over 90% of car damage are
377
REFERENCES
(1) Bennett, C., Insurance Dictionary, translation
by Daniela Moroianu, Trei Publishing house,
Bucharest, 2002, ISBN 973-8291-26-7
(2) Insurance Supervisory Commission Annual
Report, 2007-2012, ISSN 1841-7256
(3) INSURANCE PROFILE Magazine, 2007 2014 collection ISSN 1841-740X
(4) www.1asig .ro
(5) www.asfromania.ro
(6) www.csa-isc.ro
(7) www.daune-auto.ro
(8) www.unsar.ro
(9) www.unsicar.ro
MANAGEMENT
Table 1
Evolution of compensation limits for property damage, bodily injury and death for MTPL policies in
Romania during 2007-2013
Indicator / Year
Compensation
limits for
material
damage (Euro)
Compensation
limits for
injury and
death (Euro)
2007
100.000
2008
150.000
2009
300.000
2010
500.000
2011
750.000
2012
1.000.000
2013
1.000.000
350.000
750.000
1.500.000
2.500.000
3.000.000
5.000.000
5.000.000
Source: Authors data procession, information provided by the ISC annual reports from 2007-2012.
Table 2
Evolution of general insurance underwritten premiums and insurance compensations for car insurance for
the Romanian insurance market in the period between 2007 and 2013
Year
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
Non Life
Insurance
premiums
(thousand
lei )
5.726.752
7.068.174
7.241.584
6.639.733
6.083.943
6.454.395
6.637.648
Total
claims
3.090.977
4.143.706
5.178.480
4.797.561
4.194.673
4.453.718
4.198.252
Total motor
claims
2.527.046
3.713.643
4.487.086
4.136.792
3.643.275
3.809.847
3.687.000
Motor Hull
Claims
1.688.726
2.455.510
2.893.841
2.506.558
1.986.086
1.947.134
1.762.000
838.319
1.258.133
1.593.245
1.630.275
1.657.186
1.862.712
1.925.000
MTPL
Claims
Source: Authors data procession, information provided by the ISC annual reports from 2007-2012. For 2013 we
used information provided by FSA press releases on insurance market evolution to 31.12.2013.
378
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Table 3
Evolution of life insurance premiums and insurance claims for life insurance on the insurance market in
Romania in the period 2007 2013
Year
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
Life Insurance
premiums
(thousand lei )
1.449.037
1.868.113
1.628.162
1.665.669
1.738.367
1.802.519
1.653.555
Total Claims
and
redemptions
187.698
248.023
271.923
288.397
299.855
242.932
219.856
(thousand lei )
Source: Authors' processes of information provided by the ISC annual reports from 2007-2012. For 2013 we used
information provided by FSA press releases on insurance market evolution to 31.12.2013.
Table 4
Evolution of insurers and brokers who regulates auto damage in Romania in 2007-2013
Year
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
35
32
31
30
31
30
31
16
15
21
16
19
16
23
Source: Authors' data procession, information provided by the ISC annual reports from 2007-2012. For 2013 we
used information provided by FSA press releases on insurance market evolution to 31.12.2013.
379
MANAGEMENT
380
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The macroeconomic management implies the knowledge of correlations between the
macroeconomic indicators and their influence factors. An objective of macroeconomic management is the
efficient use of labour force. The paper analyses significant aspects of increasing efficiency of labour
force use by emphasising some timing correlations between different macroeconomic indicators, relevant
for the labour market. The analysed indicators are participation rate, unemployment rate and activity
rate. The econometric analysis supposes elaboration of an autoregressive model, estimation of
parameters, studying of Granger causality, stationarity testing, analysis impulse/response, determination
of lag length and other operations. The analysed period is 1990-2013.
Keywords: labour market, participation rate, autoregressive model, econometric model
1. INTRODUCTION
On short term the economic activity
depends on the demand. At microeconomic
level, to maximise the profit, the economic
agents are concerned to satisfy better possible
the demand, as a premise of their financial
stability. Also, an important concern is the
promotion of products to increase demand and
attract new customers.
At the macroeconomic level, aggregate
demand increases real GDP and the economy
moves toward expansion. Aggregate demand
growth is considering its most important
component: private consumption of goods and
services.
The mood of the population, monetary
policy, fiscal policy and the state of the global
economy are among the factors that can
influence private consumption.
381
MANAGEMENT
10.5
.68
10.0
.64
9.5
.60
9.0
.56
8.5
3. RESEARCH METHOD
.52
8.0
.48
1990
1992
1994
1996
1998
2000
Populatia ocupata
2002
2004
2006
2008
2010
2012
Rata de participare
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1.0
0.5
0.0
-0.5
-1.0
F-Statistic
11.8139
2.85491
Prob.
0.0026
0.1066
F-Statistic
9.95626
1.19033
Prob.
0.0014
0.3282
F-Statistic
4.10550
0.70436
Prob.
0.0277
0.5651
-1.5
-1.5
-1.0
-0.5
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
.010
.008
383
.006
.004
.002
.000
1
5
RP
10
POC(-1)
MANAGEMENT
.68
2,800
.64
2,400
2,000
.60
1,600
1990
.56
1992
1994
1996
1998
2000
2002
2004
2006
2008
2010
2012
.52
.48
.44
92
94
96
98
00
RPF
02
04
06
08
10
12
2 S.E.
F-Statistic
0.94309
10.6887
Prob.
0.3431
0.0038
F-Statistic
0.87285
1.11762
Prob.
0.4257
0.3499
F-Statistic
0.44140
1.23290
Prob.
0.7270
0.3347
384
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
5
RS
10
SU(1)
6. CONCLUSIONS
In correlation with the research objective,
autoregressive models used to study the
evolution of labor market indicators, highlight
the correlations between these and other
macroeconomic variables.
Thus, the participation rate, which is
intrinsically linked to demographic evolution
of population, is strongly correlated with
385
Years
1989
1990
rp
0.62
0.61
poc
10,946,000
10,839,500
popover15
17,552,215
17,702,916
MANAGEMENT
1991
1992
1993
1994
1995
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.63
0.58
0.56
0.55
0.54
0.52
0.53
0.51
0.51
0.50
0.48
0.49
0.49
0.50
0.50
0.50
0.49
0.49
0.50
0.50
10,786,000
10,458,000
10,062,000
10,011,600
9,493,000
9,379,000
9,022,700
8,812,600
8,419,600
8,629,300
8,562,500
8,329,000
8,305,500
8,238,300
8,390,400
8,469,300
8,725,900
8,747,000
8,410,700
8,371,300
8,365,500
8,569,600
9,057,625
17,796,308
17,628,133
17,748,687
17,870,437
17,981,825
18,082,636
18,146,764
18,190,185
18,226,785
18,295,918
18,383,003
17,976,508
18,064,890
18,145,035
18,221,714
18,250,418
18,246,731
18,249,385
18,234,744
18,210,068
18,174,982
18,144,412
18,115,350
Source: INS
Years
1989
1990
1991
1992
1993
1994
1995
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
rs
sbim
NA
1.1
3.0
8.2
8.5
8.6
9.2
7.5
6.7
7.0
7.8
8.0
7.6
9.3
7.7
9.1
7.9
8.2
7.0
6.3
7.5
8.1
8.3
7.7
7.3
NA
123,000
337,400
929,000
952,000
971,000
968,000
748,057
664,686
688,400
745,526
775,465
711,299
845,273
691,755
799,526
704,462
728,837
640,942
575,547
680,683
725,150
730,217
701,210
730,131
su
3,063
3,217
2,627
2,285
1,902
1,911
2,150
2,354
1,818
1,884
1,888
1,821
1,911
1,957
2,168
2,397
2,740
2,985
3,426
3,991
3,929
3,786
3,715
3,752
3,885
Source: INS
REFERENCES
1. Abel, A., Bernanke, S., Macroeconomics,
Addison Wesley (2001)
2. Albu L., Dinamica ratei naturale a
somajului
in
perioada
tranzitiei,
Oeconomica, vol. 1 (2004)
3. Blanchard O., Macroeconomics, Pearson
Prentice Hall, (2006)
4. Burdett K., Mortensen D., Layoffs and
Labor Market Equilibrium, Journal of
Political Economy, vol 87 (1980)
5. Busuioceanu S., Correcting Accounting
Errors and Acknowledging them in the
Earnings to the Period, Annals of
Constantin Brancusi, University of Targu
Jiu, Economy Series, Issue 5 (2013)
6. Caire G., Leconomie du travail. Des
reperes pour comprendre et agir, Ed. Liris
(1994)
7. Dobrescu E., Macromodels of the
Romanian
Market
Economy,
Ed.
Economica (2006)
8. Lardalo L., Applied Econometrics, Harper
Collins College Publishers, (1992)
9. Maddala G.S., Kim I., Units Roots,
Cointegration and Structural Change,
Cambridge University Press, (2000)
10. Mankiw N.G., Macroeconomis, Worth
Publishing, (1994)
11. Stockhammer E., Explaining European
Unemployment: Testing the NAIRU
Theory and a Keynesian Approach,
International
Review
of
Applied
Economics, vol. 18 (2002)
12. www.insse.ro
386
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Few companies are well known at
international level on the market of brand
management and consultancy services.
Interbrand, Millward Brown, Brand Finance,
Global Finance, the European Brand Institute
and many others produce annual rankings of
top 10, top 50 or top 100 Best Global Single
Brands or Corporation Brands, at World and
European level, country and regional level or
within certain industries and some social
activities.
The European Brand Institute in Vienna
analyses intangible assets as patent and brand
values. Its body of European independent
experts are annually publishing the brand
valuation studies Eurobrand for 3,000 brand
corporations in 24 countries and within 16
industries of Europe, America and Asia.
The valuation models usually focus on the
reports of financial transactions and either on
387
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
388
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
2007
Brand
Value
Nokia 32322
LVMH 29831
Unilever 25136
Telefonica 23858
Vodafone 22550
Mercedes 20483
Benz
T
18269
Deutsche
BMW
17298
Group
France
17068
Teleco
ABInBev 16873
2008
Brand
Value
Nokia 38283
LVMH 34907
Vodafone 24128
Telefonica 22550
Unilever 21638
Mercedes 21359
Benz
BMW
20061
Group
RBSGroup 19135
France
Teleco
Deutsche
Bank
2009
Brand
2009
Nokia 35220
LVMH 32365
ABInBev 26927
Vodafone 23789
Unilever 22829
Telefonica 22128
Mercedes
Benz
T
Deutsche
19123 BMW
Group
18172 SABMiller
2010
Brand
Value
LVMH 27638
Nokia 25331
Vodafone 25318
ABInBev 23604
Unilever 22212
Telefonica 21880
2011
Brand
Value
LVMH 31699
Vodafone 28505
ABInBev 25481
Nestle 25418
Unilever 24344
Telefonica 23384
2012
Brand
LVMH
Vodafone
ABInBev
Nestle
Unilever
Telefonica
Value
34306
28578
28021
27473
26022
21993
2013
Brand
Value
LVMH 39344
Nestle 34364
Vodafone 28926
ABInBev 28102
Unilever 27715
Volkswagen 23121
389
18895
19212
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
industries,
with
T
Deutsche
from
telecommunications field, on 7th position in
2007, it was not in 2008, but then on 8th place
for three successive years, from 2009 until
2011, since when it has not anymore been
ranked in top 10.
But Germany was also present in finances
& banking field with Deutsche Bank on 10th
position in 2008. It was the only year when the
finances & banking field was well represented,
also by RBS Group from Scotland, on 8th
position. The year of starting the economic
crisis in Europe, had two representatives from
finances & banking field in top 10. The
analysed period did not show other
representative in top 10 for this field.
France Telecom Group was present on the
9th place in top 10 in 2007 and 2008 then it
stopped its appearance in Eurobrand rankings
of top 10 brand corporations. The competition
of Vodafone from UK and Telefonica from
Spain, in telecommunications industry was
strong.
Figure 1. Boxplots for the top 10 European brand corporations, during 2007-2013
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
391
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Figure 2. The development potential of the European best brand corporations, during 2007-2013
392
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
393
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Figure 4. Structural changes in the value of top 10 European brand corporations, during 2007-2013
394
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
396
3.
4.
5.
6.
revised-guidance-valuation-intangibleassets
http://shop.bsigroup.com/upload/Standards
%20&%20Publications/IPM_Brand_Valua
tion_article.pdf
http://www.europeanbrandinstitute.com/
http://www.eurobrand.cc/
Best Global Brands,
http://www.gfmag.com/tools/globaldatabase/economic-data/11936-bestglobal-brands.html#axzz2ynUICnvO
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Economic performance is one of the major goals of any company. This involes important
decisions to optimize the allocation of cash resources, ie labor, raw materials, energy, capital equipment,
etc.. The objectives of the organization can be measured as effectiveness (the extent to which objectives
have been met) or as efficiency (the extent to which objectives have been achieved in the available
resources).
In this regard, it is particularly important to identify factors that influence getting the desired income and
the degree of their influence on the economic performance of the organization. This paper aims is to
realize an analysis of these factors and their degree of correlation on economic performance using
multiple regression.
Keywords: economic performance, efficiency, regression analysis, variables, correlation.
1. INTRODUCTION
Strategic performance, operational,
team or at individual level is a major objective
of any company. To appreciate the extent to
which organizational goals are achieved and
business strategies are effective, it is
imperative to define an integrated system of
indicators that can tell us at any time if our
business is going in the right direction or not.
Moreover, any management decision
should be based on a good knowledge of the
current state of the business, which is not
possible without a system of performance
indicators to inform management about the
results obtained in all key activities and
processes of the company.
397
MANAGEMENT
398
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
Incomes
(milioane
lei)
66,8
92,27
69,8
73,35
75,74
83,31
85,6
Nr.
Emplo
yees
247
233
272
256
234
212
201
Adv.
expenses
(mii lei)
23,8
28,3
27,6
26,7
30
29
30,1
Product
price
(lei)
18,3
20,5
16,5
17,6
18,4
20,02
21,2
399
MANAGEMENT
-272,23 + 2,17 + 0, 46
+ 9, 47
adjusted values are presented in Figure 6.
Figure 6. Evolution of sales revenues
achieved by the company in the period 20072013 and their adjustment.
400
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Summary
OUTPUT
Regression
Statistics
Multiple 0,98
R
R Square 0,97
Adjusted
R Square
Standard
Error
Observ.
0,94
2,23
7
ANOVA
df
SS
MS
Regressi
on
Residual
164,
65
4,97
33,0
6
493,9
5
14,93
Total
508,8
Coe
ff
Std
Error
t
Stat
272,
23
2,17
59,05
4,61
Pvalu
e
0,01
0,52
4,17
0,46
0,11
9,47
1,47
Intercept
X
Variable
1
X
Variable
2
X
Variable
3
Sig
F
0,00
8
0,02
Low
95
%
460,
16
0,51
Upp
95
%
84,3
3,83
4,21
0,02
0,11
0,81
6,44
0,00
7
4,79
14,1
MANAGEMENT
402
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
According to Constantin Noica [1], only
the European culture, at least from our
perspective, after it has experienced such
different influences (Byzantine, Romanocatholic, Italian, French, Anglo-Saxon), has
opened towards all the known cultures. As a
result, we can assert that there are, in spite of
the important differences (especially between
Eastern and Western Europe), common
cultural elements for all the member states,
common
values
that
are
protected.
Environmental protection is, with certainty,
such a value.
Environmental law may be defined as the
complex ensemble of juridical rules, which
regulate the relations established between
individuals, regarding their attitude towards
the environment, as a vital element and
support for sustaining life, in the process of
using, in economic, social and cultural
403
MANAGEMENT
2.National
legislations,
common
principles and sustainable development.
National legislations recognize the principles,
as they are formulated in international treaties,
principles that afterwards become part of
national law (in a rough estimate, there are
about one thousand international treaties that
contain environmental references. Some
international documents expressly refer to
environmental principles: The Stockholm
Declaration contains 26 principles (that must
inspire and guide the efforts of humankind in
order to preserve and improve the quality of
the environment); The Rio Declaration [4]
contains 27 principles and the Dublin
Statement [5] refers to 4 guiding principles.
Art. 6 of the Amsterdam Treaty refer to
sustainable development, concept that was
defined by the Resolution nr. 42/187 of the
U.N. General Assembly as that type of
economic development that ensures the
present needs without affecting the possibility
of the future generations to satisfy their own
needs. The Resolution refers to measures that
are meant to provide sustainable development,
such as: preserving peace, reviving growth and
changing its quality, remedying the problems
of poverty and satisfying human needs,
addressing the problems of population growth
and of conserving and enhancing the resource
base, reorienting technology and managing
risk, and merging environment and economics
in decision-making
The Charter of Fundamental Rights of the
European Union [6] stipulates that a high
level of environmental protection and the
improvement of the quality of the environment
must be integrated into the policies of the
Union and ensured in accordance with the
principle of sustainable development. The
principle is based on art. 3, para. (3) of the
Treaty on the European Union and articles 11
and 191 of the Treaty on the functioning of the
European Union, and also on the provisions of
national constitutions [7].
In Romanian legislation there is a
distinction
between
the
means
of
implementing general principles and strategic
elements. Art. 35 of the Romanian
Constitution recognizes the right to a healthy
environment.
404
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
405
MANAGEMENT
406
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Due to its impact over social life and its effects on the environment, the war has been an
important subject of interest for jurists all over the world, as attempts were made to incriminate its
devastating impacts. As a result, the conflict phenomenon has become an object of study for international
public law, international humanitarian law and international criminal law.
Keywords: environmental law, armed conflicts, international law
1. INTRODUCTION
International law offers a framework in
which the relationships between national states
take place.
The international framework, meaning the
international situation of a country, its
relations with the neighbors, with the regional
or international communities, have a strong
influence over the law, as there is a tendency
to harmonize national regulations with
international ones, with the signed treaties and
conventions and even in unifying law, in some
areas [1].
The first recorded use of environmental
warfare dates back to 512 B.C., when the
Scythians practised a scorched earth policy on
their own territory, in order to prevent the
Persians from advancing [2]. The rules of war
are as old as war itself and the war is as old as
life on earth [3].
Ecological protection during armed
conflicts refers to the limitation of new and
407
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
MANAGEMENT
410
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The authors point to the importance of the use of emotional intelligence for preparation
of professional soldiers. They are concerned with development, conceptions and models of
emotional intelligence as well as with specific features of military education. The authors pay
considerable attention to self-evaluation of students and pedagogical staff in the field of
emotional intelligence. They evaluate opinions of the Slovak Armed Forces members who
participate in career courses and propose other possibilities of emotional intelligence
development in the environment of the Armed Forces Academy by means of courses of study and
professional and lifelong training courses.
Keywords: emotional intelligence, commanders personality and his key competences, influence
of emotional intelligence in the Slovak Armed Forces, level of emotional intelligence within
military education at the Armed Forces Academy, innovation of professional and lifelong
education by means of emotional intelligence development for professional soldiers
1. INTRODUCTION
Enhancement of education has been
given the highest priority at all types of
schools, regardless of the their scope, because
quality of education significantly affects the
whole society. Teachers at the Armed Forces
Academy (hereinafter AFA) make every effort
to enhance their work and work better. Within
the study programmes they propose curricula
that would enhance the students competencies
necessary for the performance of their future
work and their success in their jobs. One of the
411
MANAGEMENT
412
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
MANAGEMENT
414
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
415
Types of areas
Self-awareness
Self-regulation
Motivation
Empathy
Relations and
team work
Hypothesis of
students EQ
points
assigned of
the max.
number of
6 points
3,91
4,25
4,07
3,58
% of the
max
number of
points
65,2
70,8
67,8
59,7
4,19
69,9
4,03
67,1
MANAGEMENT
Skills
evaluated as
worst
Selfassessment
3,68
Self-regulation
Adaptability
4,73
Innovation
3,82
Motivation
Optimism
4,23
Loyalty
3,77
Empathy
Sence for
policy of
organization
3,85
Focus on
customer
3,48
Relations and
team work
Schopnos
spoluprce
a vzjomnej
podpory
4,77
Willingness
to change
3,41
Areas the
skills belong to
Self-awareness
Respondents
6
9
5
7
4
10
7
5
53
416
of
assigned
points
4,36
4,71
4,48
4,24
% of
points
72,7
78,4
74,7
70,7
4,44
74,1
4,45
74,2
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Department
of
Management
Department
of
Electronics
Department
of
Mechanical
Engineering
Know
yourself
Interpersonal
relationships
Reliability
4,83
Conscienti
ousness
4,83
Cooperation
and support 4,83
Loyalty
5,33
Innovation
5,2
Influencing others
5,6
Department
of
Informatics
Department
of Social
Sciences and
Languages
Security and
Defence
Department
Department
of Science
and Foreign
Relations
Education
Department
Total
Reliability
4,57
Focus on customer
4,5
Conscienti
ousness
5,5
Cooperation
and support 5,5
Loyalty
5,71
Understand others
5,29 Cooperation
and support 5,29
Conscienti
ousness
5,6
Reliability
5,0
Conscienti
ousness
5,15
Cooperation
and support 5,6
Cooperation
and support 4,94
Department of
Management
Department of
Electronics
Department of
Mechanical
Engineering
Department of
Informatics
Department of
Social
Sciences and
Languages
Security and
Defence
417
Conscienti
ousness
4,71
Know
yourself
Selfconfidence
3,17
Selfcontrol
3,33
Initiative
4,33
Ambitions
4,33
Selfcontrol,
adaptability,
loyalty 4,0
Sebaovldanie
3,86
Sebadvera a
optimizmus
3,25
Selfcontrol
3,90
Interpersonal
relationships
Leadership skills
3,33
Focus on
customer 3,56
Enhancing
diversity 3,60
Focus on
customer 3,71
Enhancing
diversity and
willingnes to
change 2,75
Understanding
others 4,40
MANAGEMENT
Department
Department of
Science and
Foreign
Relations
Education
Department
Total:
Selfknowledge
3,71
Selfknowledge
4,0
Self-control
4,09
Selfknowledge
4,25
Rozvoj diverzity
4,30
Influencing
others 3,71
Leadership skills
3,71
Enhancing
diversity 3,80
Enhancing
diversity 3,94
Sense for policy
of org. 4,06
Employees
Students
4,36
72,7
3,91
65,2
Self-regulation
Motivation
4,71
4,48
78,4
74,7
4,25
4,07
70,8
67,8
Empathy
Relations and
team work
Hypothesis of
EQ
4,24
4,44
70,7
74,1
3,58
4,19
59,7
69,9
4,48
74,2
4,03
67,1
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Number of
respondents
Return of the
set task
60
5,00 %
29
22
75,86 %
29
18
62,06 %
118
43
36,44 %
MANAGEMENT
420
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
REFERENCES
421
MANAGEMENT
422
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
THE INTERALLIED CONFEDERATION OF RESERVE OFFICERSCIOR, AND PERSPECTIVE OF RELATION WITH EX-SOVIET UNION
(E-SU) STATES IN THE CONTEXT OF CRIMEA CRISIS.
ROLES OF THE PARAMILITARY ORGANIZATIONS AND MILITIA
OF ETHNIC MINORITIES IN THE POLITICAL AND MILITARY
TURBULENCE THEATRE
LCDR. (AF-Res.) Ioan PITICAR
Air Force Academy Henri Coanda, Brasov, Romania
Abstract: The Interallied Confederation of Reserve Officers commonly referred to by its French
acronym CIOR, represents the interests of over 1.3 million reservists across 36 participating nations
within and beyond NATO, making it the worlds largest military reserve officer organization. Founded
in 1948 by the reserve officer associations of Belgium, France and the Netherlands, CIOR is now a
NATO-affiliated, non-political and non-profit umbrella organization of member nations national
reserve officer associations.
This presentation will deal possible future relations between NATO/CIOR on the one hand, and
Ukraine, Moldova, or the South Caucasus States on the other hand, in conditions when Russia tending
to recreate the Soviet old territory, in the context of events and of the recent evolution from Crimea.
The reservists role from paramilitary or militia organizations based on Ethnic Minorities, was used
very efficient in Crimea by Russian forces, in order to reach their objectives in operations in an
efficient and quickly manner.
This abstract intend to present the implication of paramilitary or militia organizations, based on
Ethnic Minorities, in conflicts between states, like an asymmetrical option that could lead to civil war
and to the terrorist acts, out of any control of the states.
Keywords: CIOR, Crimea, paramilitary, militia, civil war, reservists.
1. Roles of CIOR
423
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
425
MANAGEMENT
Yet
Bochkarev,
the
Simferopol
commander, said Russian involvement is key.
The fact that our Russian brothers are here
gives us 100 percent confidence, Bochkarev
said.
Between Sevastopol and Simferopol, cars
stop at a militia checkpoint. Men in
camouflage gear open trunks and scrutinize
documents.
People are taking part to protect Crimea
from Ukrainian radicals, said Grigory, a traffic
controller who declined to give his last name.
I wont leave this position until I know we
are all safe, he said.
Russia succeded to take over Crimea, but
several factors make it harder to believe that
Russia will be able to establish control and to
effectively annex Crimea as it did with South
Ossetia, Abkhazia and Transnistria. For one,
the Ukrainian side so far has not made any
moves that Russia can credibly present as a
provocation that necessitates armed response
by the Russian side to protect its military or
its citizens, as was the case in Georgia in 2008.
The new Ukrainian governemnt leaders
have called for calm, the far right Right Sector
said it will not be sending its men to Crimea,
and in a conciliatory gesture to Russianspeakers, acting president Turchynov recently
vetoed the law the Ukrainian parliament
adopted several weeks earlier repealing the
2012 law elevating the status of the Russian
language.
With the Security Council in session to
discuss events in Crimea and Western leaders
urging restraint and warning Russia that
violations of Ukrainian sovereignty and
territorial integrity are unacceptable, there is
hope that a diplomatic solution to the crisis
could be found quickly.
But even if diplomacy fails and the Russian
military annexed Crimean territory with the
intention of controlling it permanently, it will
be much harder for Russia to establish control
of Crimea than it was in South Ossetia,
Abkhazia and Transnistria.
The main reason for this is the Crimean
Tatars.
7. Tatar Response
The militias structure is already similar to
a regular army, according to Leonid Lebedev,
a spokesman. Funding comes from donations,
he said. Younger members are often barred
because of their pro-Ukrainian position,
Andrei Kratko, an activist from Yalta, a city in
the south of Crimea where around 100
vigilantes patrol streets, said by phone.
The build-up of Crimea militias was
boosted after February 26 clashes between
pro-Russia activists and Crimea Tatars near
the regional parliament in Simferopol,
Lebedev said.
The Tatars see the role played by the
militias differently and have called for a
United Nations peacekeeping mission.
They come, try to provoke a conflict and then
armed gentlemen appear, Refat Chubarov,
who leads the Tatar minoritys executive, told
reporters last week.
The Tatars a Muslim group that was
deported en masse from Crimea by Stalin in
1944 and that for decades has waged a
peaceful struggle for the right to return
have been coming back in droves since 1989.
According to the latest Ukrainian census from
2001, 243.433 Crimean Tatars account for
12.1 percent of the Crimean population of
2.033.700.
They represent a highly mobilized and
unified constituency that has consistently been
pro-Ukrainian and opposed to pro-Russian
separatism on the peninsula. Going back to the
1991 independence referendum, the narrow
vote in favor of Ukrainian state independence
in Crimea may have been thanks to the vote of
the Crimean Tatars.
Since then, the Crimean Tatars and their
representative organ, the Mejlis, have
cooperated with the pro-Ukrainian political
parties. Leaders of the Mejlis such as Mustafa
Dzhemilev and Refat Chubarov have been
members of the Ukrainian parliament elected
on the party list of Ukrainian nationalist
parties such as Rukh in the 1990s and later
from Our Ukraine party.
On February 26, the day before the
Crimean parliament was taken over by the
armed men, Crimean Tatars held a large rally
426
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
427
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
429
REFERENCES
1. http://www.cior.net/News/2014/CIORNATO-Geopolitical-Seminar2014.aspx Security through Crisis
Management from NATO Strategic
Concept
2. www.bloomberg.net
3. http://time.com/42683/crimeas-tatarscondemn-annexation-seek-autonomy/
4. http://www.aljazeera.com/indepth/opini
on/2014/03/why-do-russians-supportinterv-2014328174257483544.html
5. http://www.aljazeera.com/indepth/opini
on/2014/03/crimea-crisis-tatarstanfactor-2014314143349496558.html
6. http://www.aljazeera.com/indepth/opini
on/2014/03/crimea-tatars-homeland-atstake-2014355402511335.html
MANAGEMENT
430
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This action displays a scientific research on statistical analysis based on Spearmans
correlation coefficient, in order to show the management possibility of implementing a complex
motivational system for public internal auditors. The analysis was based on the results of the
questionnaires sent by e-mail to public pre-university and university education audit structures, and on
the establishing the mathematical analysis model of the results and their review. The analysis results are
summarized in the conclusions drawn from empirical research.
Keywords: correlation coefficient, complex motivational system, public internal audit, statistical
analysis, logical analysis, regression, descriptive analysis.
JEL: M 42
I. INTRODUCION
The importance of the research stays in
the ensuring of the possibility of
implementing a complex motivational system
(Nicolescu O., Verboncu I., 2008, pp. 291
292) [6] for public internal auditors by the
public entity management from the research
field. This analysis is part of the scientific
approach of the activity and public internal
audit structure management, in order to
maximize the audit contribution to the
assuring of the public entity performance, by
assuring the management of efficient and
effective risk inventory and the efficient,
effective and economic use of public entity
431
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
possibility of rejecting the void hypothesis (pvalue). Like so, the causality relation between
the implied variables were analyzed by using
the Methodical Logit Model (MLO) (Hosmer
D.W., Lemeshow S., Sturdivant R.X. 2013, p.
528) [5]. The choice of methodology is not
random, it is assessed by the variables nature,
which are not quantitative, asserted by
concrete measuring, but their values can be
ranked. In case of obtaining a positive value
and statistic eloquent for the coefficient of the
factor variable Xj, it can be said that a
accession of the values if this variable leads to
accession of the possibility of obtaining high
values for Y variable. In case of obtaining a
eloquent negative factor, the interpretation is
contrary; if the factor acquired is statistically
insignificant, we cant reveal a casual relation
between Xj and Y, no matter the factor sign.
c1 , c j c j 1 , c5 conditions that
ensure that the sum of the probabilities for
each respondent equals 1.
2.2.
Prob( yi j | x, b, c)
exp(cj 1 xib)
exp(cj xib)
where,
indexes respondents to the
questionnaire
yi = value of the endogenous variable (item
that we consider as a result)
if
the
respondent
answered
yi 1
"never" yi 2 if the respondent answered
sometimes
yi 3 if the respondent answered often
yi 4 if the respondent answered always
xi = vector of explanatory variables (items that
we consider as factors)
b = vector coefficients
i 1, N
433
MANAGEMENT
Variable code
COMPLEX_MOTIVATIONA
L_SYSTEM
RESPECTING_LEGAL_REG
UALTION
IMPACT_ RESOURCE
Explanation
Item 1
The management task is to ensure a complex
motivational system, decent for the auditors
Item 2
Does your audit activity concern respecting the
legal regulation within the field?
Item 3
Was your internal audit activity affected by the
lack of resources needed for its well function?
Item 4
TASKS_AUDIT_DEADLINE Were the goals and tasks, established by the
management for you, accomplished in time?
Item 5
GOALS_ENTITY_RELATIO
Do the relations compiled by you respond well to
N
the goals established with the management?
Item 6
ETHICAL_CODE
In your current work, have complied with the Code
of Ethics for auditors?
Item 7
AUDIT_EXTERNAL_EVALU In the past five years, were there external audit
ATION
missions of your entity?
Item 8
ASSURANCE_PROFESSION Does the management support the work of
AL_PREPARING
professional training of auditors?
Source: Author Protected
Table nr. 2. Research results
Nominal and
percentage
Item 1 Item 2
values
Answer 1
13
4
Answer 2
22
7
Answer 3
20
7
Answer 4
17
54
Answer 1 (%)
18,1
5,6
Answer 2 (%)
30,6
9,7
Answer 3 (%)
27,8
9,7
23,6
75
Answer 4 (%)
Source: Authors calculation
Item 3
Item 4
Item 5
Item 6
Item 7
Item 8
23
19
18
12
31,9
26,4
25
16,7
9
5
25
33
12,5
6,9
34,7
45,8
8
2
14
48
11,1
2,8
19,4
66,7
3
9
7
53
4,2
12,5
9,7
73,6
17
11
24
20
23,6
15,3
33,3
27,8
9
20
16
27
12,5
27,8
22,2
37,5
434
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Coef.
Std.Er.
p-value
RESPECTING_LEGAL_REGLEMANTATIONS
***1.171
0.426
2.75
0.006
TASKS_AUDIT_DEADLINE
***1.223
0.357
3.43
0.001
**0.712
0.363
1.96
0.050
ETHICAL_CODE
N = 72 ; pseudo R2 = 0.2723
***, **, * : considerable statistic at an apron of 1%, 5% si 10%. All the factorial variables are statisticly
435
MANAGEMENT
436
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Preliminary conclusions.
From the
descriptive analysis, we can see that the
437
MANAGEMENT
BIBLIOGRAFIE
[1] Bailes C., 1998 L'analyse statistique des
donnes.
L'outil statistique appliqu au
marketing et la gestion, Chotard et Associes
Editures, Paris;
[2] Chareille P., Pinault Y., 1996 Statistique
descriptive, Ed. Montchrestien, Paris;
[3] Chelcea S., 2007 Methodology of
sociological
research,
quantitative
and
qualitative methods, Ed. Economic, Bucureti;
[4] Green E, 1992 Econometric analysis, ed.
Prentice Hall, New York;
[5] Hosmer D.W., Lemeshow S., Sturdivant
R.X. (2013) - Applied Logistic Regression, Ed.
Wiley-Blackwell, 528p.
[6] Nicolescu O., Verboncu I. 2008
Fundamentele managementului organizaiei,
Ed. Universitar, Bucureti;
[7] The Central Unity for Harmonizing the
Public Internal Audit, 2007 2012 Report on
the activity of the public internal audit,
Bucureti (www.mfinante/ucaapi/), (UCAAPI);
[8] *** Low 672 / 2002 republished low
concerning the public internal audit;
438
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
439
MANAGEMENT
440
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Many critics argue that the institution of modern school, and the teachers as educational agents
are not just incapable to stimulate, but also seem to block the innate creativity of the students. The
research described in this paper is a literature review aiming to identify the key factors that influence the
creativity in the educational environment in order to formulate practical actions towards an education for
creativity. We propose a new model of creativity in the educational context, and conclude that a reformed
school remains the main social instrument for promoting creativity.
Keywords: creativity, models of creativity, education for creativity
1. INTRODUCTION
We have sold ourselves into a fast food
model of education, and it's impoverishing our
spirit and our energies as much as fast food is
depleting our physical bodies says Sir Ken
Robinson in [19].
Though the development of creativity is
claimed to be an imperative objective of
modern education, there are surprisingly few
educational initiatives dedicated to fostering
creativity of students. Xu et al in [28] have
made a thorough inventory of the courses
dedicated to fostering creativity in universities
from North America, Europe, Japan, and
China. Surprisingly, they only found only 39
such courses, and in most cases these were
isolated initiatives of individual professors
well known for their interest in the research of
creativity. And despite the billions of Euros
invested by the European Union in lifelong
learning programmes, we identified only two
441
MANAGEMENT
442
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
EXPERTISE
CREATIVE
THINKING
SKILLS
C REATIVITY
TASK
MOTIVATION
443
MANAGEMENT
DOMAIN
KNOWLEDGE
EDUCATIONAL
ENVIRONMENT
EXPERTISE
CREATIVE
THINKING
SKILLS
C REATIVITY
TASK
MOTIVATION
444
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
445
MANAGEMENT
446
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Considering its close interrelation with the economic performance of the organizations, the
concept of innovation has been extensively studied in the past decade, from a variety of perspectives
(economy, business management, entrepreneurship, knowledge management, marketing).
The result is that innovation appears to be so complex, and so difficult to understand and to assess,
that it ressembles the story about the blind men and the elephant. Therefore, the purpose of this
discussion paper is to shed some light on the terminology related to innovation, in order to explain some
of the fallacies of the Romanian national strategy for Research, Development and Innovation.
1. INTRODUCTION
By comparing the Forbes list of most
powerful
and
valuable
brands
(http://www.forbes.com/powerful-brands/list/),
and the list of most innovative companies
according to Boston Consulting Group
(http://www.forbes.com/sites/susanadams/2013/09/
27/is-apple-the-worlds-most-innovative-companystill/) (see Table 1), two things become obvious:
MANAGEMENT
INPUT
OUTPUT
10%
5%
5%
High Tech
20%
Researcher
concentration
20%
20%
Manufacturing Capability
20%
Tertiary efficiency
Patents
448
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
449
MANAGEMENT
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
451
MANAGEMENT
452
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Anca ANDRONIC*
*Faculty of Psychology and Pedagogy, University Spiru Haret, Braov, Romnia
Abstract: Although distance education gets an increasingly special attention, emphasis should be put on
the importance of style and strategies that have the greatest impact on the quality of distance learning.
This may involve different technologies used alone or in combination. As such, there must be made a
series of decisions on choosing the most effective methods which respond best to the established goal. The
emphasis is therefore put on the role of facilitator as opposed to the role of "provider" specific for the
traditional system.
Keywords: distance education, strategies, methods, impact
1. INTRODUCTION
Although distance education gets an
increasingly greater attention, we should focus
on the importance of style and strategies that
have the greatest impact on the quality of
distance learning. Facilitating virtual learning
requires some new approaches in order to
practice and manage the teaching and learning
precess. For the program to be effective it
requires a whole new mental set about
technology.
Many institutions spend significant
resources - not just time and money - to
introduce distance education and invest
considerable in creating new technologies
required for distance courses and their proper
management.
Also, it takes the teacher to learn to
manage critical dimensions generated by the
new learning environment in which such as:
change of role, metaphor, culture, awareness
and collaboration.
453
454
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
455
REFERENCES
1. Jigu, M. Consilierea carierei. Bucureti:
Editura Sigma (2001).
2. Jigu, M. (coord.). Tehnologiile informatice i
de comunicare n consilierea carierei.
Bucureti: Institutul de tiine ale Educaiei
(2002).
456
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Rzvan-Lucian ANDRONIC*
*Faculty of Psychology and Pedagogy, University Spiru Haret, Braov, Romnia
458
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
459
460
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Rzvan-Lucian ANDRONIC*
*Faculty of Psychology and Pedagogy, University Spiru Haret, Braov, Romnia
Abstract: Theories on volunteering are various in origin (they come from sociology, social
assistance, psycho-sociology, political science), reflecting the diversity of forms of manifestation
of this type of prosocial behavior. Malina Voicu and Bogdan Voicu (2003, 2004) conducted a
synthesis of these theoretical explanations, which I will refer to in the first part of this section. I
will also present the five theoretical models of volunteering described by Peggy A. Thoits and
Lyndi N. Hewitt (2001) and at the end of the article I will refer to the interpretation of
volunteering in terms of the sociology of emotions.
Keywords: volunteering, motivation, social emotions.
1. INTRODUCTION
Malina Voicu and Bogdan Voicu (2003)
conducted a synthesis of different theoretical
approaches of volunteering , considering that
they can be classified into two major
categories :
- A first category of explanations focuses on
the different types of resources or
characteristics (social capital, human capital,
income, gender affiliation and age, urban /
rural environmen) and their contribution in
the production of voluntary behavior . After
the identification of these resources we can
create a " perfect profile " of the volunteer in a
certain culture , beginning with the identified
sociodemographic characteristics ;
- A second category of explanations is based
on the beliefs and values of the volunteers and
461
462
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
463
REFERENCES
1. Chelcea, Septimiu i Zodieru, Alexandru.
(2008). Emoiile - o construcie social. n
Septimiu Chelcea (coord.). Psihosociologie.
Teorii, cercetri, aplicaii (pp. 355-376). Iai:
Editura Polirom.
2. Chelcea,
Septimiu.
Sociologia
(2007).
emoiilor: teorii culturale. In Sociologie
Romneasc. Volumul V, nr. 2/2007, 149-163.
3. Eckstein, Susan. (2001). Community as GiftGiving: Collective Roots of Volunteerism. In
American Sociological Review, nr. 66, 829-851.
4. Rigman, Cristina. (2008). Volunteers in
Romania: A Profile. Cluj-Napoca: Centrul
pentru Studiul Democraiei.
5. Saulean, Daniel. (1999). Sursele sociale ale
vieii asociative i filantropiei n contextul
tranziiei. www.fdsc.ro/documente/22.pdf
6. Smith, David Horton. (1994). Determinants of
Voluntary Association Participation and
Volunteering: A Literature Review. In
Nonprofit and Voluntary Sector Quartely,
nr.23, 243-263.
7. Thoits, Peggy A. i Hewitt, Lyndi N. (2001).
Volunteer Work and Well-Being. In Journal of
Health and Social Behavior, Vol. 42, Nr. 2,115131.
8. Voicu, Bogdan i Voicu, Mlina. (2003).
Volunteering in CEE: one of the missing links?.
In Bogdan Voicu i Horaiu Rusu
(editori).Globalization, Integration, and Social
Development in Central and Eastern Europe
(pp. 57-66). Sibiu: Editura Psihomedia.
9. Voicu, Bogdan. (2005). Voluntariatul. In
Penuria pseudo-modern a postcomunismului
romnesc. Volumul I. Schimbarea social i
aciunile indivizilor (pp. 121-136). Iai: Editura
Expert Projects.
10. Wilson, John i Musick, Marc A. (1997). Who
Cares? Towards an Integrated Theory of
Volunteer Work. In American Sociological
Review, nr. 62., 694-713.
11. Wilson, John. (2000). Volunteering. In Annual
Review of Sociology, nr. 26, 215-240.
464
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Cristiana BALAN
The Faculty of Psychology - Pedagogy, Spiru Haret University, Brasov, Romania
Abstract
The moral life has its values, norms and its courts, it ensures respect for values that transcend the direct
interest of the person and makes one think of the others, accepting and protecting them and promoting
their interest as a real purpose. To reach all these, we need to take an educational step of asserting the
moral good and denying the moral evil and for all these to become real, a lot of work, sacrifice, passion
and dedication are needed and the work of a psychologist can hope to be an integrated element in such a
construction. This is an ascertaining study which addresses the prison system as a whole, from the
experience within a single prison, but at the same time, it addresses the whole society which includes this
particular prison. The points of interest and also the research objectives were to identify the degree of
perception of moral values among young prisoners, attitude determination and the acceptance degree of
the prisoners regarding moral education activities during detention; forming documented opinions on the
most effective moral education activities for prisoners.
Keywords: moral education, moral culture, set of values, the factor of rehabilitation
465
2. RESEARCH OBJECTIVES
We wish to mention that in this paper we
only present the beginning of a research
provided as permitted by the subjects
condition, that of prisoners in a prison.
Therefore, the objectives, even if they have
the size of a much more daring project, relate
to the expectations commensurate with the
possibilities and the motion space of the
subjects given the circumstances.
We propose, therefore, the following
objectives:
Identifying the perception of moral
values among prisoners;
Determining the attitude and the
acceptance by prisoners of moral
education activities during detention;
Formation of documented opinions on
the most effective moral education
activities for prisoners.
3. WORK HYPOTHESES
Based on the proposed objectives and the
pattern of scientific data gathered in the first
part of this paper, we considered useful to
submit to testing and evaluating the following
hypotheses:
1. Most prisoners have a valid perception of
ethical values, but have a negative assessment
of their ability to respect and promote these
values;
2. Among the prisoners there is a hierarchy of
preferences for cooperation with educational
factors, depending on the degree of
involvement;
3. Most prisoners recognize the seriousness of
the offenses for which they were condemned
and appreciate positively the role of detention
in their social behavior correction.
4. THE POPULATION STUDIED
Sampling difficulties were evident during
the research. The requirements imposed by the
representation scientific requirements in
conjunction with voluntary request, forced us
to draw in research only those prisoners who
have shown interest to our theme, so some of
the prisoners got away from the theme - those
466
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
467
468
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
469
REFERENCES
1. Dobrinoiu, V., Neagu, N. Drept penal,
Partea special, Teorie i practic
judiciar.
Editura Wolters Kluwer,
Romania (2008).
2. Stinger, P. (editor). Tratat de etic.
Editura Polirom, Iasi (2006).
3. *Strategia sistemului penitenciar
2009-2013. Educaie i asisten
psihosocial
adaptate
nevoilor
persoanelor
custodiate,
n
http://www.anp-just.ro
4. *Educaie moral i reintegrarea
social a deinuilor n penitenciar, n
http://psihoforce.info
470
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Cristiana BALAN
The Faculty of Psychology - Pedagogy, Spiru Haret University, Brasov, Romania
Abstract
This paper addresses certain behavioral disorders in prison environment, and also their nature and
content of adolescent offenders and recidivists. The socio-dynamic criminal behavior is analyzed in
general and that of the recidivist offenders as well, there are also established the correlations between the
factors that contribute to the social maturation, the formation of collective consciousness in relation to
the accelerated pace of somato-psychic development, the endogenous or exogenous conditions that favor
a development that is early, disharmonic, perverted and masked, which, by their persistence, maintain the
criminal phenomenon confirmed by the psychological evaluation. Behavioral disorders have an upward
trend, and we observe within the first step the repeating of the same type of crime (the mono-criminal),
then a second stage which is the polymorphic phase (the specialization of relapse), and the last stage is
that of the general recidivism. The probability of recidivism is highlighted by eight factors: heredity,
abnormal character, educational environment, educational problems, and consciousness of self,
inappropriate use of time and entertainment, the gender and the severity of crime committed.
As strategies of recovery regarding the criminal personality predisposed to recidivism, we propose the
following measures of social intervention: family adjustment, vocational adjustment, social adjustment.
An important role in this regard plays the social rehabilitation measures, to improve ecological
conditions of the individual (in family, workplace, at school, in the community group), by specific social
actions, focusing on psychological counseling of young offenders by specialized people.
Keywords: behavioral disorders, prison environment, crime, recovery strategies
472
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
473
interview-based survey
anamnesis
personality questionnaire 16 PF(R.B
Cattell)
Starting from the general considerations that
that in the deviant behavior socio-dynamic we
must observe the action of social factors, since
the period of the formation of personality, so
primarily in environmental conditions (family,
school, close entourage) [3]. and emphasizing
that the analysis of personality, its antisocial
incidents, the psychopathological aspects
sociopatologice which motivate them, we can
state that the research hypothesis and
objectives of the work are confirmed.
The research examines socio-dynamic the
behavior of offenders in general, of recidivists
particularly, establishes the correlations
between the factors contributing to social
maturation, the formation of collective
consciousness in relation to the accelerated
somatic development, the endo or exogenous
conditions favoring early disharmonious,
perverted, masked development, which, by
their persistence and chronicity, maintain the
phenomenon confirmed by the tests applied.
The dissonance found between social
maturity and delayed social maturation is one
of the main factors of criminal behavior.
Behavioral disorders have an upward
trend, as follows:
as a first phase, we observe the
repetition of the same kind of offenses
(the mono-criminal phase);
the second phase is the polimorf one
when the relapse specializes;
the last phase the general relapse[4].
474
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3. Butoi,
T.S.,
Criminologie:
comportamente criminale. Bucureti:
Editura Solaris Print ((2009).
4. *Legea
nr.
275/2006
privind
executarea pedepselor i a msurilor
475
476
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
477
THE DOER
THE DECIDER
passive,
depending on the
others;
is lacking the
power of will in
taking decisions,
in
overcoming
inveterate habits
proactive,
selfknowledge;
the identification/
feeling of its own
value;
self-esteem,
personal strength;
high self-reflection,
and cultivating
other, better and
more
effective
habits;
uncertain,
a
product of what
is happening or
has happened;
victim of the
situation, of the
circumstances;
it is the reflection
of other people's
opinions
and
indications;
is lacking own
reflection;
is lacking an
authentic
understanding of
the real joy and
happiness;
is lacking vision,
unclear
orientation
in
life.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
continuous training (post-school, postuniversity, for specialists, in our case for the
educational personnel with teaching, leading,
guiding and control functions).
The restructuration of the educational system,
which should cope with the humanisation and
socialisation requirements, provided in the
curricular objectives of the new millenniums
start, requires a higher accent in waiving the
informative-reproductive education in favour
of
a
formative-applicative-productive
education; in this vision: (a) on institutional
level - the achievement of the challenge of the
current school on training for active postschool life (professional, civil and family); (b)
on the level of the sub-system of initial
training - streamlining the curriculum
management by achieving the curricular
objectives of general training by means of the
application tools for such curriculum.
The initiation, promotion and leadership in the
activity of managerial training on all education
levels, formal and informal, of a new
orientation of stringent actuality, materialised
in actions specific to the age and training level
regarding the education of the liability/
responsibility spirit (pre-school education,
primary education, gymnasium), the formation
of the capacity to decide for oneself
(gymnasium and high school), from where it
results the training on all ages of the
independence of thinking and acting, which
stimulates initiative, in the end it will give
shape to a complex, realistic and general
programme of formation of the decider in a
society of knowledge, computerisation,
freedom and democracy specific to the rule of
law, globalisation of the living, cooperation,
solidarity, collective and individual security
standards.
The given thematic represents a novelty in the
current school managerial theory and practice,
in the meaning that until new it did not
presented a particular concern and teaching
research was not sufficiently approached,
although, based on all appearances, it was
intuited, assumed, therefore implicit, but
"undiscovered", and a certain obvious concern
was at the personal appreciation, as an isolated
initiative and individual possibility.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
483
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
Androniceanu
A.,
Managementul
schimbrilor. Valorificarea potenialului
486
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
17.
Zlate
M.,
Tratat
de
psihologie
organizaional managerial Vol. I - Iai:
487
488
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The educational exercise constitutes a complex situation, where previous knowledge is
always subject to facts, being mandatorily contextualised in accordance with the realities from the
educational process.
One of these precursors is the psychological knowledge - more precisely
psychological "lecturing", understanding and signification of the education situation, with all the
components and interactions making it. We hence propose the method of empathy in the educational
process, which can naturally develop the personality and the self of the students.
Keywords: Empathy, capacity, teaching professional training, communication, reshuffle, model.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
capacities
assigns
to
an
interdependent character to the
empathic
capacities,
the
formation of an empathic capacity
implicitly
leading
to
the
formation of other empathic
capacities. The principle is
deduced from the analysis of the
empathy
features,
which
demonstrated that an empathic
feature
necessarily
implies
elements of other features.
By contents of training the empathic capacity
we understand the theoretical matters on the
concept of empathy, the nature and its
functions, the psychological mechanism of
formation, the factors influencing empathy in
communication, the features of empathy
related to the evaluation criteria of the
communication relation professor-student, the
particularities of manifesting empathy of the
teachers in their relations with the students.
The forms of the empathy-forming activity are:
collective, in group, individual, in pairs. The
collective and group activities can be
performed within the continuous professional
training courses, within the methodological
meetings, seminars, prelections, trainings. The
individual activity can be performed in
parallel with the group one, as also separately,
and it involves: theoretical documentation in
the matter of empathy problematic; study on
the structure, mechanism and features of the
empathy; application of the knowledge in
interpersonal communication; drafting the
work sheets. The activity in pairs is efficient
in making some diverse exercises.
The methods for forming empathy have been
conventionally classified in evaluation
methods, applied in the determination and
control experiments, and training methods,
applied in the training experiment.
493
Applied
evaluation
methods:
testing,
enquiring, conversation, observing the
professor-student relations, the study of the
analytical programmes.
Applied training methods: exhibition,
explication, prelection, debate, brainstorming,
essay, exercise, case study, work sheets.
Training conditions. There were established
for an efficient formation of the empathic
capacity, the following conditions: initiation in
the problem, becoming aware of the need for
form the empathic capacity and the empathy
features related to the evaluation criteria of the
communication relation professor-student;
complying with the principles at the basis of
the model, appropriate application of the
methodologies.
The stages of empathy-forming
1. The initial evaluation of the empathy of
the teachers and of certain aspects of
the professor-student relation. The
evaluation is made by means of tests
and enquiries
2. Becoming familiar with the purpose of
the training objectives, with the
principles, forms, methods and
conditions for forming empathy. This
is an initiation and explication stage.
3. Using the results of the evaluation in
order to form empathy. Establishing,
by teachers, the own level of empathy
and its features. Drafting the
individual scheme of the levels of
formation of the empathy features.
Evidencing
the
low-developed
features in relation with the others.
Taking the decision to grant special
attention to the low-developed
features, but without disregarding the
other features of empathy.
4. Detailed knowledge upon the basic
notions on empathy and motivating
the need for form the empathy
capacity. In this stage, the basic
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
496
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Mobbing is a less known phenomenon in Romania, but its effects are real and worrisome. It is a
form of psychological abuse in the workplace, carried out by either colleagues or superiors through
repeated aggressive acts. This kind of psychological pressure frequently leads to affecting the well-being
of the victim either by loss of self-esteem, feelings of victimization, depression, psychosomatic disorders,
insomnia, self-destructive behavior (alcoholism), a drop in work efficiency, acute stress and posttraumatic stress. In organizations where mobbing takes place, there is an obvious decrease in
productivity. In order to prevent this type of behavior, there needs to be an accurate understanding of the
act of mobbing in all contexts. (organizational, professional, individual)
Keywords: psychological harassment, emotional abuse, intimidation, mobbing, psychological pressure
1. INTRODUCTION
Heinz Leymann was the first psychologist to
put forward the idea of mobbing in specialized
literature. He borrowed the term mobbing
from animal psychology expert Konrad
Lorenz, who had observed and studied
behaviors of isolation/exclusion among
animals, more explicitly the attacks of a group
of smaller animals against a bigger one.
The mobbing phenomenon has been studied as
early as the 1990s in several European
countries such as the Scandinavian countries,
Great Britain, France, Italy and Spain. It
basically refers to actions of intense
psychological abuse carried out against an
employee with the purpose of making him
resign his job, in the circumstances where
firing/relocating him would lead to legal
troubles for the employer. The employee can
497
medical
498
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Initiation of tasks.
In larger
companies, managers have tried to
design tasks as simple as possible and
automatize them in such a way that less
qualified staff is needed to complete
them. Mobbing may appear as a result
of lack of activity or boredom.
Basically, the perpetrator chooses a
victim to pass the time.
Task management. Improper task
management can be a trigger because
work situations inevitably generate
conflicts. If the system is not organized
properly, the dispute may lead to
mobbing. Improper task management
implies: overload of work activities for
an individual, both in quantity and in
difficulty, absence of clearly defined
rules and norms, work interferences.
Management of employees. If done
through abuse of power, it may lead to
499
REFERENCES
7. CONCLUSION
500
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: This paper aims to address the question of how success is viewed today as a result of
individual behavior, in terms of internal motives and external factors leading to the adoption of certain
attitudes for successful people to reach. Success is closely linked to the effort, leaders say, this is the
attitude that each person should adopt in order to fully realize what he wants and to reach this state,
being covered by every person access to education (Ilut, P. 2004, p. 31). To this end, we conducted three
surveys that we've applied to a sample of 180 subjects, so that we can draw some conclusions regarding
the importance of motivation and attitude to succeed.
Keywords: psychological factors, attitudes, behavior, success.
1. INTRODUCTION
A successful business fulfills a clear objective,
accurate recognition of success established by
other community members. Success is
personal and customized to each of us and is
characteristic of every community in part
(Bland, G. 2000, p 23). Success in
performance, is the optimum of the target that
we want to go and that we find, given that we
gain appreciation for the achievement of the
aim (Harrington, D. 2002, p. 54, Jenson, R.
2004, p. 48). Success can be viewed as a state
that is reflected both internally and externally.
This requires knowledge of personal qualities
and confidence in them, in direct proportion to
the work and passion to achieve it. Success
can be met by any person, if desired, sought
and pursued consistently, if opportunities are
offered what are valued regardless of the
obstacles. Attitude is a "relatively stable way
501
502
7.
DATA ANAL
INTERPRETATION
YSIS AND
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
503
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
505
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
507
508
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract : The purpose of the present research is theoretical, empirical and practical. Thus, we tried to
highlight and observe the difference between the parents of children diagnosed with schizophrenia who
have dysfunctional cognitive schemas and the parents who have mentally healthy children and the way in
which some differences are more pronounced in the first case than in the second.
The research was conducted on a sample of 89 people, divided into three groups: the first group
comprised 29 patients with a diagnosis of paranoid schizophrenia and schizo-affective disorder, the
second group comprised 29 parents of schizophrenia patients and the third group, consisting of 31
subjects, parents of mentally healthy children with no family history.
The conclusions argue that there are significant differences in terms of dysfunctional cognitive
schemas among parents of schizophrenia patients and parents of mentally healthy children.
The dysfunctional cognitive schemas found in parents with schizophrenia children are even more
pronounced than those of mentally healthy children; they were supported by checking the average scores
obtained by each participant.
Key words: Maladaptive cognitive schemas, Etiopathogeny, Schizophrenia.
Introduction
This research takes as its starting point
the ideas of Laing (1959, cited in Hayes and
Orrel, 2003, p 35), claiming that
"schizophrenia does not simply occur without
any apparent cause, but because the personal
lives of individuals are intolerable and that "a
retreat into madness" is often the only way
you can solve the contradictions they are
subject to." The same author argued that
psychiatry has failed to integrate in the
diagnostic the stress that schizophrenics often
bear and which in many cases justifies their
disorders. Studies on the role of social and
family factors are based on the research of
Faris and Durham (1939, cited Chirita and
509
510
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
p1
g9
p6
g14
p3
g1
g6
g3
p5
g10
g12
g16
ED
-.27
-.033
-.059
.107
-.058
.024
.175
.294
.039
-.229
-.083
.030
-.058
AB
-.49**
.101
.082
.102
-.128
.110
.016
.142
.055
-.080
-.105
-.173
-.211
MA
-.151
-.164
.055
.174
-.032
-.032
-.062
.434*
.111
-.123
-.247
-.108
-.165
-.613**
.103
-.004
.299
-.099
-.116
-.111
.275
-.030
-.164
.173
.090
.134
DS
-.058
-.221
-.485**
-.242
-.201
-.185
-.061
-.242
-.264
-.068
.006
.023
.227
FA
-.280
-.081
-.026
.147
.093
.124
.138
.219
-.011
-.063
.012
.024
-.049
DI
-.272
.065
-.097
-.217
.021
-.078
.063
.032
-.342
.000
.039
-.058
-.299
VH
-.282
-.088
-.303
-.019
-.079
-.148
.070
-.136
-.177
-.014
-.173
-.135
.160
EM
-.347
-.054
-.301
.341
.008
-.143
-.005
.131
-.044
-.060
.197
.161
.198
ET
-.525**
-.009
.075
.174
-.180
-.267
-.035
.111
-.230
-.168
.020
.072
-.015
IS
-.088
-.193
-.351
-.041
.095
-.291
.122
-.264
-.329
-.149
.179
-.118
.171
SB
-.064
-.331
-.493**
-.304
-.230 -.440*
-.281
-.209
-.157
-.190
-.124
-.063
.276
SS
-.224
.181
.104
-.022
.279
.062
.153
-.113
-.052
-.128
.512**
.225
.271
AS
-.154
-.277
-.044
.342
.035
-.280
-.046
.200
.152
-.272
.157
-.215
.239
NP
-.047
-.432*
-.161
.309
.207
-.265
.066
.100
-.244
-.150
.071
-.010
-.139
SI
512
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
EI
-.129
.285
-.068
-.188
.177
.090
.252
-.162
-.116
.218
.122
.030
-.067
US
.107
.156
.209
-.011
.190
.258
.077
-.068
.066
.376*
-.151
-.068
-.098
PU
.048
.046
-.208
-.038
-.144
.126
.166
.133
.105
-.305
.018
.074
-.099
Correlations
** Correlation is significant at the 0.01 level 2-tailed
* Correlation is significant at the 0.05 level 2-tailed.
513
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
516
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
paradigm
extending
the
modeling
schizophrenia to socio-communicative level.
References
Andrasik, F. (Eds.) (2006). Comprehensive
Handbook
of
Personality
and
Psychopathology,
Adult
Psychopathology (Vol. 2). John Wiley &
Sons.
Birt, M. A. (2001). Clinical PsychiatryProlegomena. Cluj-Napoca: Dacia.
Chirita, V. & Papari, A. (Eds.). (2002).
Psychiatry Treaty (Vol. 1). Constanta:
Fundatia Andrei Saguna.
Dindelegan, C. M. (2008). Cognitive Schemas
in Depression. Oradea: University of
Oradea.
518
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
519
Introduction
The world we live in is constantly
changing and this is happening at a dizzying
pace that continually puts to test our capacity
of resilience. In order to adapt oneself to
environmental requirements, it is necessary
that cognitive structures that filter out reality
do not present major distortions. These
structures, called cognitive schemas, are
different beliefs we have acquired in early
childhood. Among them we find the belief that
we are more or less able to achieve the desired
results, by using our skills or the belief that we
are either or not able to control our own lives.
A significant importance in adaptation is
also the person's attributional style, more
precisely the way he assigns the occurrence of
positive or negative events. Such attributions
may be internal or external, stable or unstable,
global or specific. The way these attributions
combine depends on how the person adapts to
the stressors of his/ her life.
In this paper we wanted to present the
issue of stress perception, depending on the
attributional style of people diagnosed with
depression and of clinically healthy
individuals.
Chapter I
Theoretical aspects
1.1 Depression: Definition and conceptual
delimitation
Currently, it is believed that emotional
experiences, normal oscillations of affection
are shown on a continuum between a negative
pole- represented by depression and a positive
one- euphoria, these oscillations having many
nuances within these two poles. Most people
are in a state of emotional stability, but in
some cases, due to changes to the
environment, due to a vulnerability in the
personality structure of an individual, this
state is disturbed and the emotional
experiences can be movable toward one pole
or another, showing dysthymia. Consequently,
the difference between a normal sadness or
grief and depression is quantitative, not
qualitative. A clear indicator of experiencing
520
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
521
F(1,236)
118,11
.000
Level of negative
attributional style
(LNAS)
0,17
.679
Interaction between
(DC) i (LNAS)
2,12
.146
Diagnosis Category
(DC)
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Depressi
on group
Control
group
Level of
negative
attributional
style
Average
Standard
deviation
High
80,50
11,82
High
65,63
65,63
6. Banyard H. , Hayes N.
(1994),
Psychology : Theory and application,
Chapman & Hall, London
7. Bban A. (1998), Stress and
personality, Cluj University Press, ClujNapoca
8. Blaney P. H., Chapter Stress and
Depression In Adults: A Critical
Review in Field T.M. , McCabe P. M.s
book - editor, Neil Schneiderman N.
(1985), Stress and Coping , Lawrence
Erlbaum Associates, Hillsdale, New
Jersey
9. Beck A.T., Ward C. H , Mendelson
M. , Mock F., Erbaugh J., An Iventory
for measuring Depression, Archives of
General Psychiatry, No. 4, 561-571
10. Bora C. (2004), Selfeficiency and
School Performance, Annals of the
University of Oradea, Psychology
Fascicle, Vol. VI pg 104-116 ,
University of Oradea Publishing House
11. Carr A. (2001), Abnormal Psychology ,
Psychology Press, Philadelphia
12. Carpenter B. N. (1992), Personal
Coping: Theory, Research, and
Application,
Praeger Publishers,
Westport, CT
13. Carver C. S., Scheier M. F. Weintraub
J.K. (1989), Assessing Coping Strategies:
A
Theoretically Based Approach, Journal
of Personality and Social Psychology ,
Vol. 56,
No. 2, pg . 267-283
Larousse
14. Sillamy N. (2000),
Psychology
Dictionary,
Univers
Enciclopedic
Publishing
House,
Bucarest
15. Dindelegan C. (2006) Elements of
Psychopathology
and
Clinical
Psychology, University of Oradea
Publishing House, Oradea
16. Engel B.T. , Capitolul Stress is a
Noun! No, a Verb! No, an Adjective in
Field T.M.s book, McCabe P. M.editor, Neil Schneiderman N. (1985),
Stress and Coping, Lawrence Erlbaum
Associates, Hillsdale, New Jersey
17. Folkman S., Capitolul Making the
Case for Coping in Carpenter B. N.s
book, (1992)
Personal Coping:
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Lawrence
Erlbaum
Associates,
Hillsdale, New Jersey.
26. Lefcourt H.M., Miller R. S., Ware E.
E., Sherk D. (1981) Locus of control as
a modifier of the relationship between
stressors and moods, Journal of
Personality and Social Psychology,
August , Vol. 41, No. 2 , pg. 357-369
27. Lu L. and Chen C.S. (1996),
Correlates of coping behaviors:
Internal and external resources,
Counselling Psychology Quarterly,
Vol. 9, Nr. 3 September 1996 , pg 297
- 307
28. Maciejefwski P. , Prigerson H.
,Mazure C. (2000), Self- Efficacy , as
a mediator between stressful life events
and depression symptoms. Differences
based on prior depression , British
Journal of Psychiatry, No. 176, pg .
373- 378
29. Marian M. I. (2005), Health and
Disease Psychology , University of
Oradea Publishing House
30. Marian M. I. (2004), Models of Anxiety
and Depression, Annals of the
University of Oradea, Psychology
Fascicle, Vol. VI pg 145-168 ,
University of Oradea Publishing House
31. Marian M. I. (2002), Adaptation on
the Romanian population of the
Attributional Style ASQ- pilot study,
Annals of the University of Oradea,
Psychology Fascicle, Vol. II, pg 288304 , University of Oradea Publishing
House
32. Martinko M. , Thomson N. (1998), A
Synthesis and Extension of the Weiner
and Kelley Attribution Models , Basic
and Applied Social Psychology, Vol.
20, No. 4 February, pg 271 284
526
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. Introduction
In order to use eficiently the notion of
career we are going to refer to a number of
significant conceptual delimitations. John
Arnold (2001a) presents eight definitions of
the concept of career. According to the
specialised literature there are many others.
Three of them, belonging to Super, Perlmutter,
& Hall i Gary Johns, underline the essential
aspects of career. If Super (1978) considered
career as a succession of professions, jobs and
positions taken by a person along its life,
Perlmutter i Hall (1992) sustained that the
career is the ensemble of jobs characterized by
training and experience, while a person
reaches to superior positions, described by
responsabilities and competences. Gary Johns
(1998) defines career as an evolving
succession of professional positions a person
could have. As it can be noticed, the mutual
aspect of the three definitions is that of
527
Table 2 . The working force (16-64 years) registered in 2008,according to gender and averages
(Investigation of working force in administration,2009)
Total
Masculin
Feminin
Urban
Rural
Active population
10.059.000
5.590.000
4.469.000
5.492.000
4.567.000
Employed population
9.493.000
5.228.000
4.265.000
5.116.000
4.377.000
566.000
362.000
204.000
376.000
190.000
11.469.000
4.900.000
6.569.000
6.348.000
5.121.000
71,2
66,4
6,5
Percentage
55,8
53,1
4,6
61,8
57,6
6,9
65,8
62,8
4,2
Unemployed
Inactive population
Activation rate
Employement rate
Unemployment rate
63,5
59,7
5,6
528
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
ian.
feb.
martie
aprilie
2008
383.989
379.779
374.050
352.466
340.462
345.510
352.912
364.183
376.971
403.441
2009
444.907
477.860
513.621
517.741
526.803
548.930
572.562
601.673
625.140
653.939
683.123
709.383
2010
740.982
762.375
765.285
738.187
701.854
mai
680.782
iunie
679.495
675.790
670.247
645.453
633.476
626.960
2011
614.976
600.308
539.666
493438
338.298
iulie
337.084
august
sept.
oct.
nov.
dec.
10,00
9,00
8,00
7,00
6,00
5,00
4,00
ianuari f ebruar
e
ie
martie
aprilie
mai
iunie
iulie
august
sept
8,10
8,33
8,36
8,07
7,67
7,44
7,43
7,39
7,35
7,08
6,95
6,87
7,26
7,36
7,43
7,20
6,90
6,70
6,77
6,84
6,78
6,54
6,38
6,20
8,82
9,16
9,17
8,80
8,40
8,08
7,99
7,85
7,85
7,55
7,44
7,47
6,74
6,58
5,92
5,41
5,99
5,80
5,24
4,85
7,41
7,27
6,52
5,90
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
531
Bibliography:
http://www.dugule@scu.ro/site/index.php?option=com_co
ntent&view=article&id=110:noul-cod-al-munciioportuniti-provocri-perspective&catid=37:activitatirecente&Itemid=86.
532
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
2. THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK
Learning strategies are seen as part of the
cognitive skills necessary for the practice of
various tasks leading to fluent performance,
that is to automaticity when performing a skill.
For cognitive psychology, learning is a shift
from controlled to automatic processing [12],
meaning that conscious attention to the task is
necessary before the automatic stage is
reached. The more consciousness allotted in
the first stage, including metacognitive
monitoring, the more profound the learning is.
Metacognition here can be seen as a process
that enables the learners to make their mental
representation become explicit in order to
analyse knowledge effectively [12].
Metacognition, defined by the Great
dictionary of psychology as "all the activities
in which the subject gets to know its own
knowledge tools or manages their functioning"
[1], has been introduced by John Flavell in
1976 to define awareness of thought process,
as well as the ability to monitor this process.
Metacognition represents what people know
about cognition in general and about their own
cognitive processes, in particular, as well as
how they use this knowledge to adjust their
information processes and behaviour.
Metacognition may be the missing link
in school learning [11], the thing that
differentiates individuals with similar innate
potential as concerning their performance.
Thinking about what we think, how we think
when we face a certain task or situation and
why we think in a certain way are levels of
metacognitive awareness; metacognition also
covers the ability to monitor these processes.
Papaleontiou-Louca [13] underlines the fact
that metacognition, on one hand, and learning
and development, on the other hand, are not
equal, metacognition meaning the process of
regulating learning and development.
Metacognition takes the form of
metacognitive
experiences,
knowledge,
objectives or goals and activities or
strategies. Flavell [apud 5] presents
metacognitive experience as the conscious
feelings that we have about our own
cognition during an activity, feelings like we
do not understand something or that we are
completely cognitively engaged in that
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
535
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
537
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
REFERENCES
Marele dictionar al psihologiei. Bucuresti:
Editura Trei (2006)
Boekaerts, M., & Corno, L. Self-regulation
in the classroom: A perspective on
assessment and intervention. Applied
Psychology: An International Review,
54(2), 199-231 (2005).
Cazan, A.M. Strategii de autoreglare a
invatarii, Brasov: Editura Universitatii
Transilvania (2013).
Elliot, A. J., McGregor, H. A., & Gable, S.
Achievement goals, study strategies, and
exam performance: A mediational
analysis.
Journal
of
Educational
Psychology, 91, 549563 (1999).
Goh, C. Metacognitive Instruction for
Second Language Listening Development:
Theory,
Practice
and
Research
Implications. RELC Journal. 39 (2), 188
213 (2008).
Huang, J. Metacognition training in the
Chinese University Classroom: An Action
Research Study. Educational Action
Research. 13 (3), 413 434 (2005).
Iwai, Y. The Effects of Metacognitive
Reading
strategies:
Pedagogical
538
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
539
540
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract This paper attempts to draw attention on the importance of communication in the
classroom, as a means of solving conflicts and on the method to solve future conflicts through student
participation in the counseling program.
Communication is an open process, influenced by many factors. The concept of "barrier" in the
communication process designates several categories: barriers related to the system, process, message,
reception, understanding, acceptance, action.
Communication blockages could have such intensity so as to produce noticeable differences
between the information transmitted and the message perceived. Ineffective communication leads to
loneliness, conflicts, family problems, professional dissatisfaction, psychological distress, physical illness
and even death when communication is completely disrupted.
The lack of conflict resolution skills was observed in students who had inappropriate
communication style.
Being a student these days is a difficult task. During this period the requirements and
expectations of society accumulate, becoming the source of many conflicts and tensions.
Working with students represents an important and beautiful activity, but a very difficult one. To
be a true teacher means understanding the needs, the way of thinking of the students and acting
thereunder when teaching the lesson.
In classes where the ability to solve conflicts is reduced, most of the time is spent on solving such
conflicts that arise during breaks and during the day.
Appropriate means of communication contribute significantly to choosing the adequate conflict
resolution strategy.
1. INTRODUCTION
The purpose of this research is to
analyse to what extent there is a significant
influence of offering counselling services for
conflict resolution on the ways of resolving
541
542
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
543
3. FINAL CONCLUSIONS
The art of communication is not a
natural process or a skill we are born with. We
learn to communicate. Therefore we need to
study what we learn in order to be able to use
our knowledge more effectively. Any
communication
involves
creation
and
exchange of meanings. These meanings are
represented by signs and codes. It seems
that people have a real need to "read" the
meaning of all human actions. Observing and
understanding this process may cause us to be
more aware about what happens when we
communicate.
Counselling provides support to the
individual in exploring and understanding
his/her own identity, supports him/her in
developing strategies for problem solving and
decision making. In counselling four
directions derived for the problems approach
of problems that individual may face during
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
545
BIBLIOGRAPHY
1. Adler
B.R.,
Rodman
G.
Understanding Human Communication, New
York.(1985).
2. Bban, A. (coord.). Consilierea
educaional. Cluj- Napoca. (2001).
3. Birkenbihk,
Vera.,.
Antrenamentul comunicrii sau arta de a ne
nelege. Bucureti: Ed. Gemma Pres. (1997).
4. Butnaru, D. (coord.), Consiliere i
orientare
colar.
Ia i:
Ed.
Spiru
Haret.(1999).
Helena,
Faire,
5. Cornelius,
Shoshana, tiina rezolvrii conflictelor.
Bucureti: Ed. tiin i Tehnic. (1996).
6. Deutsch, M. Educaia pentru o
lume panic n Psihosociologia rezolvrii
conflictelor. Ana Stoica Constantin. Iai: Ed.
Polirom.(1998).
7. Dumitriu, Gh. Comunicare i
nvare. Bucureti: EDP.(1998).
546
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Elena HURJUI
Department of Psychology and Pedagogy, Institution: Spiru Haret University, Braov, Romania
Abstract The democratization of social life imposes education preparing children and
adolescents to face their limits and with the condition of satisfying personal needs in the context of
reciprocal social relations. The existence of students who do not adapt to the requirements of the
educational environment represents the reality of any educational system. In Romania, this phenomenon
is highlighted by the low school grades, low test scores, second examinations and grade repetition,
absenteeism and school abandonment.
The significant proportion of students with school difficulties requires the reassessment of this
problem and finding new solutions for preventing school failure in disadvantaged children by the ratio
between the institution and their individual and family characteristics. Individual determinants of school
difficulties are often backed-up by the institutonal determinants and cause some children to enter the
downslope of failure or partial achievement of learning potential. Through a proper task mediation, by
encouraging the transfer from similar learning activities, by learning strategies and concepts, through
personal development activities and optimization of emotional and social skills, the child may acquire the
ability to overcome the typical performance level and to access a higher performance level.
Keywords: communication, conflicts, barrier, information, message, inefficient communication
1. INTRODUCTION
Purpose of the research
This study aims at counseling children
from disadvantaged environments by applying
a customized intervention program and
investigating the opportunities for personal
development to increase adaptation capacity
to a specific context of learning to overcome
school difficulties and to avoid school
abandonment.
547
b) Socio-emotional adaptability
assessment scale
In order to assess the socio-emotional
adaptability and the socio-emotional maturity
level of preschoolers we have designed the
socio-emotional adaptability assessment
scale.
Objective: To identify strengths
(resources) and weaknesses (vulnerabilities) in
preschool children.
Customized intervention program
This program provides an insight on how
we can help children become happy, to have
an unconditional self-acceptance and to
become active subjects in their own learning
process. The program will provide a range of
real life situations that are applicable to
children from all socio-economic and cultural
environments. Different situations will be
addressed: poor performances in tests or at
school, dealing with unfairness and rejection,
coping with disruptive family situations and
inducement to violence and school
abandonment by the group the children belong
to. The activities will use the game as a
method of teaching and learning to make the
children aware that they are in a learning
situation and to determine them to use rational
thinking skills, to develop unconditional selfacceptance, to experience problematic
emotions and to stop destructive behaviors.
The methods used are inspired by classical
psychodrama (J.L. Moreno) and from the
structural-cognitive
changeability
theory
(mediated learning) of Professor R.
Feuerstein.
The program contains "exciting
lessons" adapted both to educational
framework and to counseling framework and
presents a stimulus activity adapted to the
development level, aimed at developing the
skills necessary to cope with this stimulus and
containing summarizing questions and
sequences which allow children to make the
transition from intellectual insight to the direct
application of concepts and skills in real life.
The ascertaining experiment, as a
preliminary step of the research, aimed at
identifying age, gender, neuropsychological
development level and socio-emotional
548
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
550
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
BIBLIOGRAPHY
3. CONCLUSIONS
Through this paper I wish to
emphasize the importance of counseling
children in forming their personality and in
their preparation for life.
The increasing number of school failures
and abandonment, of delinquent or unhealthy
behaviors, of emotional disorders among students,
indicate that the school should be doing much
more in this direction. To meet these real needs,
the Ministry of Education and Research proposes
in the new National Curriculum the introduction of
the optional study discipline Counseling and
Orientation for all three levels of schooling:
551
552
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The alteration of the modern worlds principles, the relativization of values, the vanishing of
references, the invasion of the new and of the unpredictable, the hallucinating promotion of quantity and
appearances to the detriment of quality and core values, the indeterminism and uncertainty are only a
few of the traits that characterize the contemporary world and that hold an impact on the human
condition. In this context, the very status of pedagogy, as a science and art of education has modified,
whereas the perspective of enlightenment over the paideic action has come to an end. Within the
managerial type of school, learning becomes a mere transfer of useful data for the final purpose of
graduating and not a process in which actors enjoy the process itself. The paradigm of the managerial
type of school transforms the relationship educator educated, from a deeply human relationship into a
contract-based relationship. The application of European quality standards in the field of education
imposes the surpassing of mimesis, amateurism and improvisation and, not the least, a change of
mentality in all those concerned about the quality of education.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
556
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
557
558
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The European strategies in education focus on key competences as autonomous elements of
personal and professional development to be supported by specific learning activities and patterns. One
of these key competences at European level is represented by the entrepreneurial competences. From this
perspective, the need for communication and collaboration, for exchange ideas and experiences in order
to harmonize the training programs approaches is obvious. This paper is aimed to present the lesson
learnt after implementation of professional development training program on entrepreneurial
competences and the benefits for all involved, in the context of adult education. This training program
was developed throughout a European project, coordinated by the University Politehnica of Bucharest
and represents a suitable solution to transfer good practice in training field and to support mutual
learning, as specific practices in adult education and professional development, particularly. During 3
years of implementing this European project, among other specific activities aimed to promote the
entrepreneurial culture and increase the awareness, a training program in entrepreneurial field was
designed, authorized and implemented, as a key element of sustainability. The training program has
benefited of comprehensive curricula, in terms of knowledge and skills, and consists of 10 modules
focusing on development of entrepreneurial skills and competences and is addressed to employers,
employees and persons who want to start an independent activity, in order for them to get support in term
of counseling and expertise in entrepreneurial field.
Keywords: adult education, training program, entrepreneurial competences.
1.
THE ROLE OF TRAINING
PROGRAMS IN ADULT EDUCATION
From an organizational perspective,
professional development has to ensure that
the performance improvement needs are met,
generating, in this way, some adaptation and
compromise of the main adult education
principles. The application of these principles
requires practitioners to experience and
manage effectively the tension created
between adult learning characteristics and
organizations performance principles. For this
559
professional
development
training
programs).
Adults orientation to learning
is
life-centered;
therefore,
the
appropriate units for organizing adult
learning are life situations, not subjects.
Experience is the richest source
for adults learning; therefore, the core
methodology of adult education is the
analysis of experience.
Adults have a deep need to be
self-directing; therefore, the role of the
teacher is to engage in a process of
mutual inquiry with them rather than to
transmit his or her knowledge to them
and then evaluate their conformity to it.
Individual differences among
people increase with age; therefore,
adult education must make optimal
provision for differences in style, time,
place, and pace of learning.
Moreover, defining adult education as the
process of adults gaining knowledge and
expertise based on theirs goals, we need to
take into consideration the phases of the adult
learning planning process. The four phases set
up by the R. Swanson in 1996 [4] are referring
to:
- Need in order to determine what
learning is needed to achieve goals.
- Create strategy and resources to
achieve the learning goals.
- Implement the learning strategy and use
the specific resources.
- Evaluate the attainment of the learning
goals and the whole process of reaching
them.
From another perspective, one of the main
objectives the European policy in education
and training set out in the strategic framework
for European cooperation in education and
training ET 2020 [2] is focused on
improving the quality and efficiency of
education and training by enabling all learners
to acquire the basic skills and competences
needed for their employability by encouraging
cooperation between all sectors of education,
training and the world of work. This specific
important objective, emphasized at the
European level, might be achieved even using
professional development training programs
560
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
Medium
Level
High
Level
VeryHigh
Level
562
100
80
Location2
60
Location1
40
20
0
Good
VeryGood
Poor
564
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The present study has its roots in the desire to find solutions for a better teacher-student-parent
relationship. When we bring the subject of education into discussion, we find ourselves in a potential
space, the one of our development and of our all possibilities to fully round our inner selves. This space
develops and increases through the mediation of the meeting we all have, as students, with the one being
our teacher. But this world, this space is not complete if the process of our completion as individuals is
not attended by our parents, involved in an educational partnership relation. Thus, the child-parentteacher team traverses phase after phase, building a relationship within which the child manages to
develop and complete his inner self. The present study brings forward issues which are quite common
during puberty and adolescence increased aggressiveness and faulty relationships. The objectives of the
present study are to reduce the level of aggressiveness at a class level, as well as between students and
teachers, and to attract parents into being educational partners alongside their childrens teachers. The
sample used for the research was formed by a class of eight graders and their parents, observed during
an intervention done at the level of both groups.
566
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Objectives:
Identification of start indices in order
to construct and reconstruct the class
reality (with reference made to the
childrens reality doubled by the
teachers reality).
Highlighting the aspects that can be
improved, as well as the indices that
need to be kept under observation in
order to make the change (decrease of
the aggressiveness level, a better
relationship with the class teachers, and
a better relationship with the
classmates).
Attracting parents in establishing a
closer relationship with the school.
The hypotheses of the study:
The class aggressiveness level
decreases as a result of the intervention
The dimensions of the class
relationships are changed after the
personal development classes (through
relationship we understand the
teachers-students relation and the
students-students relation)
There are important differences in the
class relationships after the parents
involvement in parenting activities.
Sample Description
The sample of the present study
consisted of a class of eight graders
from an elementary school located in
the capital city and their parents.
Research Tools
The tools used during the study were
provocative tools used in personal
development and a questionnaire which
targeted the personal expectations
deriving from the research meetings.
Results and Discussions
The first part of the research had two
phases: the first phase consisted in
567
568
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
569
570
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The aim of the present study is to be a brief insight into the world of primary school children,
(grades I-IV) through the stories created and invented by them. The research is based on the assumption
that the development process of any child can be facilitated through creative methods and the first step to
achieve this goal is to gain access to the childs world. In order to obtain the necessary data for our
study, we proposed art-therapeutic group meetings, which had the purpose to activate the childrens
resources and inner potential, to improve the student-school relation, the parents-children relation, as
well as the parents-children-teacher (primary school teacher) relation. By applying the principle of
social-constructivism, according to which reality is built through conversation, we initiated a process
of building and rebuilding the childrens reality,soastoturnitintoanindividualspaceofknowledge,
selfknowledgeandpersonaldevelopment.
Keywords: story, child, personal resources, school, self-knowledge
1. INTRODUCTION
The present study has as its starting point the
numerous transformations undergone by the
primary school student throughout the school
adjustment process and during his/her change
from an ordinary child to a responsible and
involved student.
There are numerous experimental
proofs which demonstrate the crucial role of
inhibition in any activity subjected to
interference. The inhibition is a general label
applied to a group of mechanisms which have
the purpose to deactivate or partially eliminate
the answer or the metal content and to reduce
or eliminate the interference of the current
load which contains irrelevant information
(Miclea, 1999).
571
A deliberate implementation or
removal triggers the processes of cognitive
inhibition. Any deliberate mental control is
inherently associated with a process that
determines the diminishing of ones attention
and the elimination from a persons conscience
of any informational flow which might
interfere and endanger the achievement of our
intention. The starting point for the two
complementary processes is our intention to
get engaged in a mental control: one process
aims to implement attention, while the other
aims to inhibit any collateral informational
flow (from external stimuli to thoughts)
(Miclea, 1999).
The counter-intentional effect is the
opposite effect initiated by an intention to
control a state or a behavior;
572
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
573
574
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
575
576
577
Evaluate
Implement
Design
Develop
43%
57%
Female
Male
579
22%
34%
20%
24%
25 - 30 y.o.
31 - 35 y.o.
36 - 40 y.o.
41 - 45 y.o.
580
Hunters
32%
Lurkers
54%
Learning motivation
Mean
1
St.
dev.
Min.
Max.
Learning motivation
To achieve future career
aspirations
To gain qualifications
2.57
.27
1.75
3.25
3.49
1.13
2.00
5.00
3.45
1.14
2.00
5.00
1.96
0.82
1.00
3.00
2.58
1.11
1.00
4.00
2.05
0.85
1.00
3.00
2.01
0.80
1.00
3.00
By a style of learning or
learning environment
2.00
0.80
1.00
3.00
1.93
2.93
2.06
3.99
0.79
1.38
0.81
0.81
1,00
1.00
1.00
3.00
3.00
5.00
3.00
5.00
2.48
1.12
1.00
4.00
Mean
St.
dev.
Min.
Max.
3.32
3.27
3.25
3.19
0.76
0.77
0.82
0.73
1.50
1.50
1.67
1.33
5.00
5.00
5.00
4.83
3.17
0.84
1.33
5.00
Between 5
and 6,9;
33%
Between 7
and 8,9;
37%
Between 9
and 10; 16%
Lower than
5; 13%
28
HUNTERS
35
HOBBYISTS
33
582
58
14
51
14
67
Lower than 5
Between 9 and 10
Mean
2
St.
dev.
Min.
Max.
Learning motivation
To achieve future career
aspirations
To gain qualifications
3.20
3.93
0.36
0.84
3.20
3.93
0.36
0.84
3.51
1.09
3.51
1.09
2.95
1.41
2,95
1.41
3.50
1.07
3.50
1.07
2.99
1.43
2.99
1.43
2.98
1.43
2.98
1.43
2.57
1.16
2.57
1.16
3.07
3.01
1.35
1.42
3.07
3.01
1.35
1.42
3.12
1.35
3.12
1.35
4.06
0.82
4.06
0.82
2.67
1.30
2.67
1.30
583
Mean
St.
dev.
Min.
Max.
4.31
4.42
4.35
0.50
0.45
0.40
2.27
3.17
3.32
5.00
5.00
5.00
4.39
0.47
3.17
5.00
4.36
0.53
2.27
5.00
t- test
Cohens
d
Size
effect
21.433
1.54
Large
25.557
22.294
1.84
1.64
Large
Large
23.294
2.67
Large
22.000
1.72
Large
4. CONCLUSIONS
The research confirmed the general
hypothesis (Hg) that the use of ICT in adult
learning has a positive impact. The results are
visible for all the psychographic segments we
were able to identify, namely Lurkers, Hunters
and Hobbyists. However, to give an answer to
the research question asking on whom ICT has
a greater impact, it is possible to conclude that
Lurkers and Hunters had the most visible
changes in their learning behavior. They
increased intrinsic motivation for learning,
discovering that learning is enjoyable and can
be more effective in collaborative contexts. The
fact the training program blended both
asynchronous and synchronous learning
sustained the development of self-confidence
and self-perception as a learner. At the
beginning, the Lurkers expressed that they are
not able to learn and their work environment is
not so demanding. However, the training
584
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Motto. Human being need love. Life without tenderness and without love is nothing but a dry
mechanism,creakingandheartbreaking.(VictorHugo)
Summary. The researches made in psychotherapy field have proved the importance of childs
relathionship with his group affiliation and with his family, as a prereqiusite for balanced development
of childs personality and his social optimal integration. Based on this researches, we have found that the
best predictor for a harmonic childs development is given by the relationship seted between child and his
family members and the effective communication within family. For the investigation we aimed to
specifically evaluate how the child relates to other family members using structured psychological
interviw and observation, we have continued the investigation of the personality using clinical evaluation
instruments and for the personalitys restructuring we used individual and family psychotherapy. Our
desire was not only to determine and to investigate the causes of the disorder but also to implement
psychological activities in order to improve child behaviour. We have considered that the relathionship
that they have and effective communication can lead to personality rebalancing and to a good
intergration both in the family and in the psycho-social area (school).
Keywods: aggresion, children, parents, psychotherapy, personality, behaviour.
1. Introduction
In psychology is especially used the
concept of aggression while in sociology it is
used the concept of violence .
The aggression is related to the bellicose
nature of a person. This concept characterize
the dynamism of a subject that does not run
because of difficulties or fight. (Psychology
Dictionary, 2000). For many psychologist the
agression is closely related to frustration: a
child who is not free to play, clamp because
585
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
587
- family therapy
grandparents.
with
parents
and
8. Bibliography
1.
Michael
P.
Nichols,
Family
Psychotherapy, 2005
2. Marshall B. Roseberg, Be a good parent,
Elena Francisc Publishing, Bucharest, 2005
3. Stephane Clerget, Adolescence crisis,
Tree Publishing, Bucharest, 2008
4. Norbert Sillamy, Psychology Larousse
Dictionary, Enciclopedic Publishing House,
Bucharest, 2000.
588
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
THE
Abstract: The values and their organization during teenage years represent an impotant acquirement
for personality and their impact have importance both short and long terms regarding persons
behaviour during the life. We consider the determination an essential element in choosing certain values
for teenage years. Organization of the character who constantly express in different contexts of life
depends on how human values organize in this sensitive period of life of each person, even if this values
remain at a subconscious level, they represent reactions that preced and direct human behaviour. The
motivation for choosing the theme and performing the research is expressed by the interest that we have
for this age and for the proper organization of the values. We started from the premise that the values
constitute a capital, perhaps the most valuable of the human being and according this, the human can
be shown in good advantage; in this way, he adjust to social contexts in a suitable, flexible and realistic
way, he create successful socio-professional and interpersonal relathioships and live in harmony with the
other people. Hoping that this study reveals in an authentic way the essence of the psycho-moral values
internalisation, we wish we can contribute to socio-psychological education of teenagers. They represent
the basis of future society and certainly they will bring their contribution in maintaining and creating
positive attitudes for the values promoted by romanian society. The purpose of research is to identify and
to orientate personal and interpersonal values.
Key words: teenager, behavior, determination, values, character, self-adjusting, personality.
1. INTODUCTION
This work can be considered as a possible
reflexive and critical-constructive exercise
about the problems of adolescence, the
teenagers being a category/sample of youth,
most explosive, most researched and
interdisciplinary approached.
The adolescence crosses everywhere today
a non-values, challenges and incertitude
troubled world.
Romanian teenagers quickly follow the
adolescences crisis.
589
590
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
591
Valid
Masculin
Frequency
31
Percent
32,0
Valid Percent
32,0
Cumulative
Percent
32,0
100,0
Feminin
66
68,0
68,0
Total
97
100,0
100,0
is not a normally
Statistics
Subjectsage
N
Valid
Missing
97
0
18,57
18,00
18
2,533
,882
,245
1,445
,485
13
13
26
18,00
19,00
Mean
Median
Mode
Std. Deviation
Skewness
Std. Error of Skewness
Kurtosis
Std. Error of Kurtosis
Range
Minimum
Maximum
Percentiles
33,33333333
66,66666667
that
Main hypothesys : It is assumed
there are cores o
f specific values at
adolescence and these are influenced by
gender.
Meaningful values list for teenagers
indicates us the orientation of subjects in
terms of personal values that they choose.
Table no.3 The choices and rank average for values list
Statistics
Valid
Missing
Mean
Adaptability
11
86
5,82
Truth
29
68
4,55
Affection
16
81
5,81
Ambition
26
71
3,92
Good self-image
Self-Control Good leader
19
9
11
78
88
86
6,00
5,33
4,64
Good
Successful
11
Communication
Career 31
86
66
7,27
4,90
abilitues
Marriage
and family
35
62
3,54
Statistics
N
Mean
Valid
Missing
Money32
65
Earnings
5,41
Moral
11
behavior
86
5,36
Conscientiousness
Courage
8
40
Dignity
18
Open
to new
13
Discretion Balance
2
13
89
57
79
84
95
84
5,50
5,08
5,06
4,77
7,00
6,92
592
Empathy Generosity
1
21
96
76
5,00
5,10
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Statistics
N
Mean
Valid
Missing
Indulgent Impartation
1
18
Confident
8
Initiative
8
Education Freedom
19
30
79
96
89
89
78
67
6,00
5,00
7,25
4,63
6,74
5,60
7,00
5,00
7,50
Statistics
Help for
Power
N
Mean
Valid
Missing
Amiability
Patience
7
38 to influence
20
Respect
35
59
90
77
62
person in
10
need 87
5,84
7,14
6,85
6,00
6,90
593
Delicacy
10
Humility
3
Solicitude
1
Tolerance Vigilance
7
14
87
94
96
90
83
5,40
5,00
8,00
2,14
7,29
Chioces
40
35
30
25
20
Alegeri
15
10
5
0
Courage Friendship Respec
Succesfull
career
Freedom
earnings
4,5
4
3,5
3
2,5
2
1,5
Ranks Average
0,5
10
Communion
Solicitude Empathy DiscretionPatriotismPersuasionHumility MediationProblem
of conflicts
orientation
solving
8
7
6
5
4
Ambitie
Casatoria si familia
Vigilenta
Rabdare
t
-2,830
-3,818
2,210
2,736
df
25
34
13
19
Mean
Sig. (2-tailed) Difference
,009
-1,577
,001
-1,957
,046
1,786
,013
1,350
95% Confidence
Interval of the
Difference
Lower
Upper
-2,72
-,43
-3,00
-,92
,04
3,53
,32
2,38
3
2
1
Courage Friendship Respect
Marriage and
Money
Succesful
earnings
Family
Freedom
Ambition
Vigilance Patience
career
594
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Table no.5 Significant diferences between boys and girls in terms of value orientation
Independent Samples Test
Levene's Test for
Equality of Variances
Self-control
F
Equal variances
assumed
Sig.
,018
,894
Equal variances
not assumed
Marriage and family
Equal variances
assumed
-2,397
3,633
,065
Equal variances
assumed
,068
Equal variances
not assumed
2,644
,034
33
,012
10,748
-2,865
,050
12
,014
8,547
-2,865
,028
7,988
2,205
4,031
Sig. (2-tailed)
17
-2,550
Equal variances
not assumed
Vigilance
df
,020
distribution
Age group
Secondary hypothesis
It is presumed
that the age of teenagers is a
differentiator/modulator factor in terms o f
values orientation.
Because the subjects age is a
continuous variable with the median placed at
18 years old, we can consider all subjects
under 18 years old small age and all subject
after 18 years old big age. The result is a new
categorial variable that distinguish between
two category of subjects and with which we
can study the effect that age group determine
over the values system.
595
Valid
Small age
Big age
Total
Frequency
58
39
97
Percent
59,8
40,2
100,0
Valid Percent
59,8
40,2
100,0
Cumulative
Percent
59,8
100,0
distribution
To verify the relation between personal and
interpersonal values of the subjects we used
Pearson bivaried correlation coefficinet.
We note that there is a significant
correlation between interpersonal values and
two personal values Marriage and family, and
Courage.
There are significant correlations, mild and
negative between marriage and dependence
(r=-0,36; p<0,05), and between marriage and
management (r=-0,34; p<0,05). The persons
for who marriage and family represent an
important value obtained lower scores at
dependence (oriented to dependence pole) and
also low scores to management (this value is
not dominant in interpersonal relathionships).
The courage, as individual values is
significantly correlated, positive and strong
with all interpersonal values. Thus the
correlation between courage and dependence
is r=0,57; p<0,01, between courage and
conformity r=-0,64; p<0,01, between courage
and social consideration r=0,67; p<0,01,
between courage and independence r=0,61;
p<0,01, between courage and benevolence
r=0,59; p<0,01 and between courage and
management r=0,58; p<0,01.
The subjects which strongly valorize the
courage they appreciate the independence in
interpersonal relationship, are non-conformist
(the only negative correlation), they valorize
the social consideration, they are independent,
kind and they tend to manage.
There are not significant differences
regarding the interpersonal values between
boys and girls or between two age groups.
Because the relations between courage as
personal value and interpersonal values are
very strong, we propose to predict the value of
the courage based on the scores obtained at
interpersonal values. For this purpose we used
linear regression as a statistical method where
we built a number of six hierarchical models,
corresponding to six predictors determined by
the inventory variables
of interpersonal
values, by which we will study the multiply
relation between them and criterion,
represented
by
courage
-,366
,575
Sig. (2-tailed)
,031
,000
35
40
Pearson Correlation
,315
-,646
Sig. (2-tailed)
,065
,000
35
40
Pearson Correlation
-,331
,679
Sig. (2-tailed)
,052
,000
N
Conformity
N
Social consideration
N
Independence
35
40
Pearson Correlation
-,281
,610
Sig. (2-tailed)
,102
,000
35
40
Pearson Correlation
-,322
,597
Sig. (2-tailed)
,059
,000
N
Benevolence
N
Management
Curaj
Pearson Correlation
35
40
Pearson Correlation
-,340
,581
Sig. (2-tailed)
,045
,000
35
40
,182
Sig.
,672
-3,155
-3,248
df
Sig. (2-tailed)
29
21,335
,003
,005
596
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
.
Table no.8 The validity of six hierarchical regression models
ANOVAg
Model
1
Sum of
Squares
96,897
Mean Square
96,897
Residual
195,878
38
5,155
Total
292,775
39
Regression
124,023
62,011
Residual
168,752
37
4,561
Total
292,775
39
Regression
148,932
49,644
Residual
143,843
36
3,996
Total
292,775
39
Regression
157,835
39,459
Residual
134,940
35
3,855
Total
292,775
39
Regression
157,853
31,571
Residual
134,922
34
3,968
Total
292,775
39
Regression
159,963
26,660
Residual
132,812
33
4,025
Total
292,775
39
Regression
df
F
18,798
Sig.
,000 a
13,596
,000 b
12,424
,000 c
10,235
,000 d
7,956
,000 e
6,624
,000 f
f. Predictors:
(Constant), Dependence, Conformism, Social Consideration,
, Bunavionta
Independence Benevolence Management
g. Dependent Variable: Courage
, Conducere
Change Statistics
Model
Adjusted
Std. Error of
R Square
R Square
R Square
the Estimate
Change
F Change
,575 a
df1
df2
Sig. F Change
,331
,313
2,270
,331
18,798
38
,000
,651 b
,424
,392
2,136
,093
5,947
37
,020
,713 c
,509
,468
1,999
,085
6,234
36
,017
,734 d
,539
,486
1,964
,030
2,309
35
,138
,734 e
,539
,471
1,992
,000
,004
34
,948
,739 f
,546
,464
2,006
,007
,524
33
,474
598
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Model
4
(Constant)
Dependence
Conformism
Social consideration
Independence
Unstandardized
Coefficients
B
Std. Error
-8,749
7,236
-,056
,083
,160
,135
,627
,217
-,198
,130
Standardized
Coefficients
Beta
-,279
,748
2,554
-,903
t
-1,209
-,675
1,182
2,890
-1,520
Sig.
,235
,504
,245
,007
,138
600
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
601
24.
www.une.edu.au/WebStat/unit_materials/c4_d
escriptive_statistics/determine_skew:kurt.html
: University of New England, Armidale, New
South West, Australia.
602
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Feminism and femininity have often been confused in relation with literary works. The
confusion consisted of attributing feminine characteristics to writings belonging to female writers.
Literary criticism has managed to clarify these two distinct concepts, and even to identify elements of
masculine writing in female authors. The novel under scrutiny, Voica, by Henriette Yvonne Stahl
displays a range of facets of femininity; nevertheless, the manner of writing is purely masculine, the
author appealing to the psychological observation, using a masculine-like language for the novels
dialogues and preserving an external realism. Apart from the gender differences, absorbed by the
supreme power of creation, the literature written by women offers a new perspective, freed from
constraints, an inner image of the topic of femininity, an autonomous space, populated by original and
very interesting characters, who appear to have been taken out from the real world.
Keywords: feminism, feminity, feminine writing, masculine writing, literary feminism
1. INTRODUCTION
Feminism and feminity are two distinct
concepts disputing supremacy in the areas of
ideology and literature, but which harmonize
with each other due to their common concern
to confer the woman a new identity and a
visibly modified and improved status.
Although feminity represents a social
construct, it is made up of both social factors
and biologically created ones. Based on the
famous feminist manifesto, launched by
Simone de Beauvoir, in 1949 - Le Deuxime
Sexe 1 , feminity has its origin in biology 2 . If
603
2. INSTANCES OF FEMINITY
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3.
4.
5.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
1. Beauvoir, Simone de. (1949) Le deuxime
sexe, Paris, Gallimard (trad. rom Al doilea
sex. 1998. Bucure ti: Univers;
2. Ibrileanu, Garabet. (1979). Studii literare.
607
6.
608
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The role and importance of continuous teacher training and formation has become increasingly
important within the context of present preoccupations for quality in higher education institutions.
Teaching staff in universities is represented by professionals that need to be permanently preoccupied
with their continuous formation and training, in order to develop both their scientific and their
methodological and psycho-pedagogical competences. The present paper present the results of a study on
the teaching staff in several higher education institutions with technical profile in Romania. The study
aimed to identifying the continuous formation and training needs, including the interest in professional
training, the domains where this is a must, the competences that need to be developed. Also the concrete
means by which formation is identified. The results of the study demonstrated the necessity of a coherent
system in professional development in technical higher education.
Keywords: technical higher education, professional training, professional skills, teaching
1. INTRODUCTION
European policies regarding professional
development in the case of teaching staff in
technical and vocational institutions represent
one of the domains of priority for the
European cooperation by education [1]. Thus,
there is particular concern at European level in
order to develop professional skills required
teaching staff from universities [2].
Within this context, the main condition for
quality education is represented by continuous
training and formation for the teaching staff in
universities.
Teaching staff in universities have a
particular
profile,
generated
by
the
professional roles they have. Their profile and
competences are complex, owing to the
609
610
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Figure 2.Experience
Figure 3. Specialty
611
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
613
3. CONCLUSIONS
The following conclusions can be drawn,
as a result of the present study:
- teaching staff in universities, irrespective
of their scientific title, are aware of their needs
for formation and professional development,
both in their specialties and related to
teaching;
614
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Neuropsychology, called by some
authors Neurophysiology, terms that do not
overlap completely, study the relation between
the central nervous system structure and
implementation of various functions, processes
and mental activities. Neuropsychology arose
from the necessity to understand the
relationship between the structure of the
nervous system and mental activity in order of
deciphering physiological mechanisms of
human and animal behavior. One must know
the structure and physiology of the nervous
system.
By function we mean the embodiment
of the activity of various structures. So the
structure is the material support of the
615
616
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
617
individuals
with
neurological
or
developmental problems.
A neuropsychological evaluation is
essential for obtaining school-based services,
testing accommodations for college entrance
examinations and accommodations in ones
place of employment.
REFERENCES
3. CONCLUSIONS &
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
Test results will establish a baseline of
current functioning that can be used as a
marker to assess the progress of
pharmacological, surgical, and rehabilitation
efforts as well as determine the course of
cerebral dysfunction and recovery.
Neuropsychological testing can help in
planning and developing remedial education,
rehabilitation and vocational programs for
618
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: The hereby paper is part of the studies and research initiated to define, evaluate and
analyze the concept of " the flight activity ", especially within those areas involving high-risk activities,
during which errors may occur and lead to catastrophic consequences, such being the case of aviation, as
well. We used a variety of documentary sources, the most relevant and up to date, and many of the issues
are accompanied by examples and statements on real situations resulting from our experience gained
both as an aviation psychologist and an associate instructor in the Department of aviation within Aurel
Vlaicu Air Force Training School, Boboc
Keywords: flight activity ,abilities, satisfaction
9
9
9
9
Average rated:
Space orientation (ability to determine
the distance and direction to the target
point);
Ability to assess correctly the distance,
the size and the shape of objects;
Ability to assess correctly the speed;
Ability to observe airfield (adequate
inspecting-exploring strategies).
Motor abilities
Highly rated:
9 Motor coordination;
9 Ability to control muscle exercise
capacity;
9 Reduced response time.
Average rated:
9 Movements reliability;
9 Automation skills;
9 Rapid reorganization of motor
skills;
9 Rapid accommodation of motor
skills to air traffic demands.
Attention qualities
9 Post voluntary attention (the skill of
paying attention);
9 Stability;
9 Concentration
(resistance
to
distractions);
9 Distributive;
9 Volume.
Intellectual qualities
Highly rated:
Highly rated:
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9 ability
620
to
deliberate
during
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
hazardous/crisis situations;
9 ability to balance properly both their
own resources and workload demands
during working hours.
Motivational and emotional traits
Persistence;
Strength;
Independence;
Timeliness ability to deliberate
quickly during a complex emergency
situation;
Personality traits
Highly rated:
Resistance to stress;
Conscientiousness;
Punctuality;
Meticulousness;
Team spirit;
Flexibility.
V. Satisfactions
VI. Hazards
Average rated:
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
Will qualities
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9 Persuasive.
Sincerity;
Responsibility;
Reliability;
Composure;
Discipline;
Self-assessing ability;
Self-criticism;
Empathy;
Sense of humor;
621
Death
Spondylosis
General bone problems / fractures
Decreased hearing
Injuries, burning and cutting lesions
Irradiation
Intoxication
Temporary or permanent disability
Psychomotor disorders
Management
Collaboration
Documents preparation
Goals setting
Establishing execution details
Tasks allocation in order to achieve the
ultimate objective with minimum
effort
Crew coordination
Co-pilot instruction
Technical computing and navigation
data
Data collection
Information sharing
Survivors "Recovery"
compensated
IX. Conversion professions
Pilot in other institutions / companies
Manager
Air traffic controller
Sports instructor
Any profession related to aeronautics
X. Means of professional training
Factors to be avoided:
Fatigue
Stress
Professional frustrations
Alcohol consumption
Drugs consumption
Medication
Negative affective mood
Psychological discomfort both at home
and at work
Individual study
Continuous practice
Greater number of flight hours
Systematic
training
on
flight
simulators
Training qualification courses with
pragmatic content
Maintaining sobriety
Training in various weather conditions
Attending all types of training (training
for instrument flight)
Comprehension of new methods of
training
Conformity with flight training
methodology
Level courses
Centrifuge training
Bilateral exercises with experienced
pilots
REFERENCES
Experience
Physical resistance
Mental strength
Regular activities / Physical exercises
Intelligence
Adaptability
Time management
Appropriate lifestyle
Calmness
Ability of detachment from problems
("A certain amount of detachment")
Proper rest
Avoiding alcohol
Proper nutrition
Understanding coming from third
parties
Creating a proper working climate
Power of concentration
Deficiencies
that
cannot
be
1.
***,
HUM.ET1.ST10.100GUI-01, Guidelines for developing and
implementing TRM, 15 Mar 1996;
***, HUM.ET1.ST10.2000-REP-01,
2.
Team Resource Management Test and
Evaluation 30 Nov 1999;
3.
Allaire,
Franois,
RovenaFrumuani, Daniela, Resursele umane i
teoria organizaiei, Bucureti, Editura
Cavallioti, 1999;
4.
Amado, Gilles, Guittet, Andre,
Psihologia comunicrii n grupuri, Editura
Polirom, Iai, 2007;
5.
Bachman,
Lyle,
Fundamental
Considerations in Language Testing,
Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1990;
622
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
6.
Bogthy, Zoltn, Manual de
psihologia muncii i organizaional,
Editura Polirom, Iai 2004;
7.
Bride, J.B., Holmes J., (coord.),
Sociolinguistics. Harmondworth: Penguin,
1972;
8.
Cole,
G.A.,
Organizational
Behaviour, D.P. Publications Ltd, Aldine
Place, London, 1995;
9.
Coman,
Alina,
Tehnici
de
comunicare: proceduri i mecanisme
psihosociale, Editura C.H. Beck, Bucureti,
2008;
10.
Cook, Guy, Seidlhofer, Barbara,
Principle & Practice in Applied Linguistics,
Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2000;
11.
Dell Hymes, On communicative
competence, n J.B. Bride, J. Holmes
(editori). Sociolinguistics. Harmondworth:
Penguin, 1972;
12.
Dulea,
Gabriel,
Sociodinamica
grupului militar, Editura Militar, Bucureti,
1991;
13.
Enchescu, Constantin, Tratat de
teoria cercetrii stiinifice, Editura Polirom,
Iai, 2005;
14.
Goleman,
Daniel,
Inteligena
Emoional,
Editura
Curtea
Veche,
Bucureti, 2001;
15.
Hopkin, V.D., Human Factors in Air
Traffic Control, Hampshire: Ashgate, 2005;
16.
Katzenbach, J., Smith, D.,
Les
equips de hautes performances, Paris,
Dunod, 1994;
17.
Kirwan, B., Rodgers,M., Schaefer,
D., Human Factors Impacts in air Traffic
Management, Taylor & Francis, Hampshire,
1995
McQuail, Denis, Comunicarea,
18.
Institutul European, Iai, 1999;
19.
Neacu, Clara, Punescu, Mihaela,
Factorul uman, element cheie n
623
624
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
A PREGNANT TEENAGER.
ASSESSMENT, DIAGNOSIS, INTERVENTION 15 YEARS LATER
Aurora SIMIGIU, PhD student
* Faculty of Psychology and Educational Sciences, University of Bucharest, Romania
Abstract: This study focuses on the evolution of the life of a teenager mother. Her personalitys
assessment takes place 15 years after she gave birth to her first child and captures her history (data
obtained through a semi-structured interview), psyco-diagnosis and items that require psychotherapeutic
intervention .
We consider important the personal assessments of a mother watching back on her teenage life as
a longitudinal approach captures the causal elements of life experiences. The psychological evaluation
was performed with NEO FFI, FFNPQ (personality test), DAS (test for relationships in a couple) and
PAXonline for assessing anxiety.
The purpose of this qualitative research is part of the desire to find answers to the following
questions: How does a teenage mother assess the decision she took 15 years ago? Does she regret it?
What impact did this decision have on her life? How is her psychic now? What can be done now to
optimize her life, from a psychological point of view? We hope this study brings more knowledge on these
life situations, more and more frequent in Romania nowadays.
Keywords: adolescent, mother, anxiety, neuroticism, case study
1. INTRODUCTION
If the pregnant teenager has been
studied in terms of case study, of counselling
and prevention strategies, based on the
fundamental theories on maternity stated by
Freud, Bowbly, Lebovic, and Winnicott or on
the online intervention (Simigiu, 2012,
Simigiu, 2013), we now approach the same
issue from another perspective - that of a
teenage mother in a longitudinal approach.
Looking back to a teen mother, 15
years later, we ask ourselves the following
questions: does she regret her decision to keep
the baby? How did this decision affect her
life? How would she advise her daughter, now
a teenager, too, if history repeated itself? How
vivid in her soul is the wound caused by the
babys father who abandoned her when she
625
626
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
627
Importance of education
She believes that education is very
important in life, even more important than
love, because it is the only one who can offer
an independent living. She has been living
with another man for the past 10 years, a man
that reminds her of her father. He often beats
her, but she says he loves her, too. She has no
regrets on having decided to give birth to her
eldest girl and she often scolds her for not
learning enough.
She would have liked to follow her
fathers footsteps in career, but she said the
pregnancy ended her dream, just like she
ended her mother's dream by coming into this
world. She thinks this is their fate. She says
that if her mother had wanted her and loved
her, maybe she would not have repeated the
ninth grade, when he ran away from home for
two days and she would not have fallen in love
with the wrong boy so early in life. Her
biggest regret is that she did not finish school
and returned to Romania after two years of
living in Switzerland.
Love and work
She does not want to talk about love
because she does not believe in it anymore. It
was a negative experience for her that taught
her that love comes together with pain. She
has a low opinion of men. All her life was
ruined because of them. She got cervical
cancer also because of men. She says she is
going to die because of them. He hates men.
Major life themes
The decision to keep her first born
child was a crucial decision, the hardest she
ever took in her life. She proved to manage it
and she did not regret what she had done. Her
two girls are her only achievements. She
regrets that she lied to her father and he died
without knowing that he would be a
grandfather. Her priority in life now is to stay
healthy and to see her girls grow up.
Vision of the future
She wants to get better and to leave the
man she is in a relationship with at the
moment, who is the father of the second girl,
as he beats her badly, he is possessive, jealous,
locks her inside the house, does not give her
any money, terrorizes her and cheats on her.
She says that she had some happy
moments in life, but few. She does not leave
628
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
629
630
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: In the majority of post-war Middle Eastern countries, marked by authoritarianism, frozen
political systems, constant destabilizing attempts and revolutions against official order, intelligence
services have become pillars for power preservation, constantly transgressing their specific objectives in
order to become control and repression instruments against both internal and external threatening
elements. Ba'athist Iraq comes as a classic example, since the new elites led by Saddam Hussein develop
and extend security and intelligence services (Mukhabarat, Istikhbarat, al-Amn al-Amm, al-Amn al-Khas
etc.), transforming them into systems with multiple tentacles, modelled by interests at the level of tribes,
clans, regions, sects, through which the regime controls an entire political and social structure, and
diffuse information throughout the complicated Middle East and internationally. After the military
campaign from 2003, all intelligence services are dissolved by new installed Iraqi government following
an advice from US officials, in order to establish new structures. In the entire post-Saddam era however,
the structures faced an infinitely complex system of threats to national security, deriving from terrorism,
insurgency, organized crime and generalized violence, from competition and rivalry between them, and
from representation of competing interests at political or confession level: Shia, Kurdish, Sunni actors,
as well as the ones between US and Iran. Taking into account the increasing authority of Nuri al-Maliki
and the projection of Iraq's destiny in a regional conflict with multiple actors, e.g. Iran, Saudi Arabia,
US, Turkey, the new Iraqi intelligence services are permanently constrained to rethink their operational
strategies and fidelity both at national and international scale.
Keywords: Iraq, intelligence, Saddam Hussein, Nuri al-Maliki, Mukhabarat, Istikhbarat, Sunni, Shia
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Journal
of
Intelligence
and
CounterIntelligence, Vol. 16, No. 2, pp.
202 211 (2003)
4. Al-Marashi I., Iraqs security outlook for
2013, ISPI Analysis, No. 197 (2013)
5. Baram A., The Iraqi armed forces and
security apparatus, Conflict, Security &
Development, Vol. 1, No. 2, pp. 113-123
(2001).
6. Baram A., Building Toward Crisis: Saddam
Husayn's
Strategy
for
Survival,
Washington: The Washington Institute for
Near East Policy, Washington (1998).
7. Bennett G., Iraqs Security and Intelligence
Structures: More Problems, Conflict
Studies Research Centre (May 2006)
8. Blanche E., Maliki takes control, The
Middle East, pp. 12-15 (January 2010)
9. Cochrane M., Malikis Authoritarian
Regime, The Institute for the Study of War
(2013)
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: To live with death can be considered a pun, but basically it constitues a starting
point for reflections upon death. In time, people everywhere have been preoccupied with
questions regarding death, loss, immortality. Thoughts about death affect life in various ways.
Some are threatening and scary, others are useful and inspiring. The thoughts about our own
death or that of close ones cause sadness, anxiety. Death threatens everything that we know and
appreciate. The meanings that we attribute to death and the reactions to these meanings are
different for each individual. The perception of death is socially determined, with significant
differences in different cultural areas. These differences appear as a result of some religious,
cultural convictions, of the environment in which the man lives, of the family atmosphere, of the
emotional climate. Attachment lies at the basis of any connection. A person who does not know
how to become attached, will never know to separate either. If the relationship of attachment has
been uncertain, then the separation phases are lived improperly and the mourning labor is not
solved. There are people who do not get attach at all, for fear of separation, there are people
who get too much attached, they are very adhesive and they experience separation in a very
difficult way. In any relationship, there are four phases: attachment, connection, separation and
mourning. If the mourning process is not accomplished, the person will not be able to get
involved in another relationship and will not connect in an authentic manner, it will be just a
substitute for the lost bonding. If mourning and grieving are not accomplished, the person will
stay mentally blocked in the past. This shows the persons inability to integrate the loss and to
move on, to adapt to a life without the deceased one .In this paper I will present the case of a
patient I have worked with in psychotheraphy from an Adlerian perspective, assisting her in
grieving the loss of her son, offering therapy and support psychological assistance to allow her
to adapt to a life without her son.
I.
CASE STUDY PRESENTATION
Case description:
639
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
642
Moral judgments:
- the ideals judge what is important
or not, good or desirable;
- basic ethic attitudes are considered
more or less an individual
psychological matter rather than a
result of mass propaganda or social
systems.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
3.
643
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Sensul
Vieii.
645
2. Adler, A. nelegerea
Bucureti, 2009
vieii,
Trei,
646
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract: Throughout the parenthood, the priority is and shall remain at all times to ensure the
physical, mental and emotional health of the child. The balanced development of the children is
determined by adequately meeting the needs involved by different development stages of the children.
Often the parents feel helpless in their capacity, being unable to identify the actual needs of their children
or approaching them wrongly, thereby generating negative effects that can sometimes mark for good the
behavior of the future adult.
Ill-treatments applied to the minor are actions of the parents or of the person to whom the child is
entrusted for raising and education, actions that seriously jeopardize the physical, intellectual or moral
development of the child. Todays generation has a much faster development rhythm. Todays children
are the future adults; the responsibility for their education lies with their parents and teachers, but the
society is not relieved from such responsibility. For the parents to successfully accomplish this
responsibility, support is required from the community, from the entire society. The parents represent the
key-elements in ensuring the observance of childs rights, as the child spends the most of the time at
home, and the parents or the adults fulfilling the role of parents have the most significant influence on
shaping the childs psyche and personality, whether they are aware of this or not.
Keywords: responsibility, influence, family climate.
1. INTRODUCTION
Each family has its own place, but also its
own role in the progress of the society. The
family as the primary element the child takes
contact with and remains the permanent and
fundamental landmark in the condition of the
individual, in manifesting civic, moral and
behavioral attitudes. The human being is the
being whose relationship depends essentially
on communication and given this, its building,
reliability and vocation cannot be explained
outside the exchange of messages. Through
communication the individual is humanized,
forms and develops its personality in a
647
648
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
649
Ageofparents
5,8%
7,12%
2,3%
15,25%
Figure 1.
650
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
651
3.
4.
5.
6.
652
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Modern man is gradually adapting to
transformations of the entire society, the real
possibility of progress and development being
influenced and especially conditioned by
education. School dropouts represents a
serious issue facing higher education. It is a
complex phenomenon within the educational
environment that is represented also in a
broader context, taking into account the
following dimensions: economic, sociocultural, ethnic, psychophysiological and
pedagogical. During the transition period, it
was found that students in increasing numbers
tend to leave the educational system. They are
surrounded by hostile family climate, careless
and disinterested attitude of the parents for the
school, an institution that is no longer a
priority and not provide and guarantee a job.
The massive emigration to the Western states,
causes improper care from parents, who offer
their children freedom of movement, which
653
654
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
655
656
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
657
2.
Boco,
Muata-Dacia.
Instruirea
interactiv. Iai: Editura Polirom (2013).
3. Chelcea, S.,. Iniiere n cercetarea
sociologic.Bucureti:Editura
Comunicare.ro. (2004).
4. Ciot, Melania-Gabriela. Educaie i
societate. Cluj-Napoca: Editura Eikon
(2012).
5. Ciot, Melania-Gabriela. Managementul
educaiei. Cluj-Napoca: Editura Eikon
(2012).
6. Cuco, C.,. Educaia. Experiene, reflecii,
soluii. Iai: Editura Polirom (2013).
7. Enchescu, Eugenia. nvarea continu.
Aplicaii
la
educaie
i
nvmnt.Bucureti: Editura Universitar
(2011).
8. Joia, Elena. Metodologia educaiei.
Schimbri de paradigme.Iai: Editura
Institutul European (2010).
9. Miller, G. John. Cum s formezi caracterul
copiilor.
Metoda
responsabilitii
personale. Iai: Editura Polirom (2013).
10. Neacu, I.,. Introducere n psihologia
educaiei i a dezvoltrii. Iai: Editura
Polirom (2010).
11. Neamu, Cristina. Deviana colar. Iai:
Editura Polirom (2003).
12. Vallieres, Suzanne. Trucuri psihologice
pentru prini. Educaia adolescenilor,
Iai: Editura Polirom (2013).
12. Videanu, Gabriela. Educaia la frontiera
dintre milenii. Bucureti: Editura Politic
(1988).
658
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
Objective: The socio-emotional
development
of
children
in
the
experimental
group
through
the
Instrumental Enrichment Program.
Hypothesis
: It is assumed that the
application of the Instrumental Enrichment
Program will lead to significant differences in
terms of socio - emotional development in
children in the experimental group.
Research
group: This research was
conducted on a total of 200 school children,
aged between 8 and 10 years, enrolled in
regular schools in Brasov. The research group
consists of 100 children with Special
Educational Needs and 100 nonSEN children,
659
SEN SEN
Non
NonSE
660
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
btopics of
selfknowledg
e
Identity
Con
trol
Experi
mental
SEN
Cont
rol
N
Experi
mental
50
50
35
46
Physical
appearan
ce
Performa
nce in
school/at
work
Preferenc
es, desires
48
40
38
29
27
39
34
47
22
31
35
49
Relations
hip
system
Views and
opinions
Searching
for self
Isolation
and selfconfidenc
e
Adaptatio
n and
social
integratio
n
Need for
self-help
and selfimprovem
ent
Attitude
toward
self
Table of
values,
16
24
31
47
17
19
32
14
18
39
43
22
15
18
23
46
12
19
33
11
22
39
19
21
43
beliefs
and faiths
Conflicts 10
and
contradict
ions
Self-ideal 15
Reflected
self
Status of
the
person
23
26
47
29
31
49
16
18
37
21
25
42
662
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
663
REFERENCES
664
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Abstract To avoid the exclusion of vulnerable children from the education system and to provide
them opportunities for social adaptation, Professor Feuerstein has developed the theory of "mediated
learning" and operationalized it in order to be used in the educational practice. Feuersteins
Instrumental Enrichment method (IE) is part of cognitive education category and focuses on that part of
education which is highly capable of change: the child and the childs teacher. This method is
successfully used in over 30 countries around the world, developing independent living skills and
personal autonomy skills for thousands of students.
namely
institutional
and
individual
determinants.
In an educational system focused
on the contents of study disciplines, the
teachers showed increasingly reduced
availability to the particular needs of the
children.
In
such
conditions
the
representative classes of the school
population showed learning or habituation
difficulties to the program imposed by the
school system, difficulties that led to the
dissatisfaction of the teachers, of the parents
and of the students. The search of the factors
that led to this situation and the accusation
of the teachers for the failures of the
children was born out of the use of medical
buffer to monitor the issue of school
difficulties, with the idea that those who do
not respond adequately to school
requirements cannot be consideres as normal
and deviate from the rule of statistical
majority. For mass education, most
problems are created by the students with
limited intelectual performances and by the
students with exceptional performance level.
These categories can hardly be included
within the limits imposed by the standard
curriculm and show specific school
difficulties.
The significant proportion of
students with school difficulties require the
reassessment of the issue and finding new
solutions to prevent school failure in
underprivileged children in the relationship
between institutional environment and their
individual and family characteristics.
Individual
determinants
of
school
difficulties are often backed up by the
institutional ones and cause for some
children their enrollement on the descending
curve of failure or partial achievement of the
learning potential. This raises a legitimate
question: "Why is the risk of school failure
emphasized throughout schooling for some
students?"
New educational systems try to
answer this question by optimizing child
development through education that
organizes "inputs", so that "outputs" of the
cognitive system to be richer. To ensure
children an internal benefit through school
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
which
together
influence
cognitive
performance.
Confidence in intellectual processes
capacities changeability does not mean
underestimating genetic influences on
intelligence. On the contrary, we start from
considering genetics as a factual situation.
Theoretical explanations of the cognitive
activation
phenomenon
are
provided
traditionally in terms of the relationship
between genetics and the environment. The
eternal issue of the relationship innateacquired, important for both the human, social
and health sciences, was resumed at the end of
the last millennium and now, at the beginning
of the new millennium, in the hope that the
place of general principles will be taken by
specific data and methods. The genetics,
however important it may be, and however
relevant are genetic research data on twins,
adoption or otherwise, does not explain the
great variability of human nature.
Psychological
research
of
environmental influences and their relevance
to the field of education tries to respond
increasingly more to the challenge launched
by Piaget, to avoid generalizations on
valuation of family and environmental
influences and finding concrete ways to
change the cognitive development progress of
a child.
The concept of cognitive education
From the theoretical perspective,
cognitive education is linked to the concepts
of intellectual potential and of the proximal
development area (Vygotski, 1971), plasticity
and adaptability of the brain (Luria, 1961,
Cohen, 1982, Changeux, 1983), mediation and
changeability (Vygotsky, 1978, Feuerstein,
1980, Nyborg, 1983). In Vygotsky's view,
cognitive mediation means the acquisition by
667
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
BIBLIOGRAPHY
1. R. Feuerstein (Ed.), Instrumental
enrichment. Baltimore: University
Park Press, 1980; J. M. Martinez
Beltrn, J. Lebeer, R. Garbo (Eds.), Is
Intelligence
Modifiable.
Madrid:
Bruno, 1998.
2. Feuerstein, R. & Jensen, M. (1980).
Instrumental Enrichment: Theoretical
basis, goals, and instruments. The
Educational Forum, 44:401-423.
3. Feuerstein, R., Klein, P., &
Tannenbaum,
A.
(Eds.)(1991).
Mediated
learning
experience:
Theoretical,
psychosocial,
and
learning implications. Tel Aviv and
London: Freund.
670
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
1. INTRODUCTION
This paper aims to study the connection
between the identity construction and psychic
maturity as fundamental elements of
personality. In addition to the clarification and
description of some important terms like
identity, maturity, Self, Ego, the
paper demonstrates the relations between the
statuses of identity and the obtained levels of
maturity, by means of scientific research. The
identity and the psychic maturity describe in
their correlation the archetypal phenomena:
Who am I? and The Great Journey. The
Great Journey (individuation, self-becoming,
actualization, Self-accomplishment) is still
present among human beings, just as it was in
ancient times.
Modern psychology is required to lay a
special emphasis on this process of finding
671
672
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
673
Work hypotheses
1. There is a significant difference from
the psychic maturity standpointbetween
subjects withidentity diffusion and those with
identity moratorium.
2. There is a significant difference from
the psychic maturity standpointbetween
subjects with identity diffusion and those
withidentity achievement.
3. There is a significant difference from
the psychic maturity standpointbetween
subjects with identity foreclosure and those
with identity moratorium.
4. There is a significant difference from
the psychic maturity standpoint between
subjects with identity foreclosure and those
with identity achievement.
Study sample
The research was conducted on a sample
of 40 persons, aged 20-40, from different work
fields. No subject selection criterion was
applied. They manifested their desire to
participate in the research and they gave their
consent to participation. The data obtained
from the research are confidential and only
used in this study. The gender repartition of
the sample was: 39% males and 61% females.
The w ork ins truments o f the
quantitative-statistical study were:
1. The objective measure of ego identity
status OMEIS, Adams, Gerald, R. (1998). It
measures the identity statuses. The test
consists of 64 items and was developed
according to Marcias theory.
2. The SLP (Styles of Living Preferences)
personality inventory was elaborated in 1983
by psychologists Gail Maul from the Riverside
City College and Terry Maul from San
Bernadino Valley College in order to capture
the traits mentioned above and established by
Carl Rogers and Abraham Maslow for an
b. Interpersonal identity
As it can be noticed in fig. 2: 17 subjects,
namely
42.5%
of
the
sample,
revealedinterpersonal identity diffusion; 3
subjects, namely 7.5% of the sample, revealed
interpersonal identity foreclosure; 5 subjects,
namely 12.5% of the sample, revealed
interpersonal identity moratorium and 15
subjects, namely 37.5% of the sample revealed
interpersonal identity achievement.
674
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
676
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
ities in
677
process
wards learning
678
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
679
Mean
4.13
4.05
2.31
2.08
Std.
deviation
1.26
.77
.66
.46
Cronbach
alpha
.77
.66
.65
.63
3.76
3.78
.58
.83
.69
.59
4.20
.84
.63
680
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Democratic
interaction
Supportive
interaction
Permissive
interaction
Unpredictable
interaction
Feelings about
School
Levene
Statistic
df1
df2
Sig.
.687
97
.506
5.828
97
.004
.933
97
.397
37.992
97
.000
.065
97
.937
Democr
atic
interact
ion
Betwee
n
Groups
Within
Groups
Total
Support
ive
interact
ion
Betwee
n
Groups
Within
Groups
Total
Permiss
ive
interact
ion
Betwee
n
Groups
Within
Groups
Total
Unpred
ictable
interact
ion
Betwee
n
Groups
Within
Groups
Total
Feeling
s about
School
681
df
Mean
Squar
e
4,324
2.162
154.300
97
1.591
158.625
99
36.342
18.17
1
23.400
97
.241
59.742
99
.242
.121
43.860
97
.452
44.102
99
2.227
1.113
18.786
97
.194
21.012
99
5.423
2.711
28.837
97
.297
34.260
99
Sum of
Squares
Betwee
n
Groups
Within
Groups
Total
Sig.
1.35
9
.262
75.3
24
.000
.268
.766
5.74
9
.004
9.12
0
.000
Mean
Democratic
interaction
relapse
status of
inmates
No
Yes
4.01
4.29
Std.
Deviat
ion
1.34
1.15
Supportive
interaction
Permissive
interaction
No
Yes
No
Yes
4.14
3.94
2.39
2.20
.81
.71
.64
.68
1.288
Unpredictable
interaction
No
Yes
1.99
2.21
.46
.42
2.372*
-1.082
1.440
Academic
No
4.45
.82
3.641*
extrinsic
*
Yes
3.86
.77
motivation
Academic
No
4.01
.75
3.326*
intrinsic
Yes
3.48
.85
motivation
* p 0.05, **p 0.001 males (n=57); females (n=43)
682
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Contact
with
family
No
Yes
Mean
Std.
Deviat
ion
.80
.88
Academic
4.28
.935
extrinsic
4.12
motivation
Academic
No
3.57
.84
intrinsic
2.649*
Yes
4.00
.77
motivation
* p 0.05, **p 0.001 males (n=57); females (n=43)
5. Conclusions:
The general objective of this study was to
investigate the differences in perception of
professor-student interaction, feelings towards
school and academic/learning motivation of
inmates held in Giurgiu Prison, according to their
age, criminal records and contact with their
families.
We appreciate that the objectives of this study have
been successfully met as the above presented
results confirmed the hypotheses.
Compared with younger inmates, the older ones
perceive the teacher as more supportive. Also, the
older inmates have stronger feelings towards
school than younger inmates. On contrary, the
younger inmates perceive the teacher as
unpredictable. The recidivists perceive the teacherstudent relationship with apprehension and
mistrust. Their relapse status also highlights their
mistrust in education system of which most of
them didnt attend it, having a lower intrinsic and
683
684
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
BECOMING A PSYCHOTHERAPIST
Loredana VCU*
*Faculty of Social Sciences, Eftimie Murgu University of Resita, Resita, Romania
Abstract: Professional development in psychotherapy represents a major impact theory in every
psychotherapists life. For a period of at least four year his professional life will be directed towards
training meetings and his life will change. For a practitioner life goes on according to clients schedules.
This material proposes an approach of a few of the most important aspects of professional development
in psychotherapy, but also the perspective of the future psychotherapist. The aspects underlined represent
the consequence of the trainers activity in an association of integrative psychotherapy training.
Keywords: professional development, psychotherapy, trainee.
1. INTRODUCTION
Training in psychotherapy represents for
many colleagues a desire that can become
reality; still it demands a profound analysis of
numerous factors. In a country in which
psychotherapy has found its way with
difficulty, during the last 24years, a paradox
has appeared: the Psychologists College from
Romania (C.O.P.S.I.) over 30 professional
associations demanded an authorization to
become suppliers of professional development.
Regardless all these, accredited associations of
the forum mentioned represent only a small
number of associations that can start courses
of professional development in different forms
of psychotherapy with a duration of at least
four years.
The Psychologists College from Romania
trusts these associations and recognizes their
right to become suppliers of professional
development in a form of psychotherapy, if
these hold at least four accredited trainers as
main psychotherapists in the therapeutic
training they promote.
685
capacity;
686
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
2.
687
3. PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT
ACCORDING TO THE TRAINEE, THE
FUTURE PSYCHOTHERAPIST
The process of becoming a psychotherapist
trainee is not an easy one. The decision to start a
professional development in psychotherapy
supposes the intervention of more factors: costs,
time and delegations.
4. CONCLUSIONS
Satisfactions are greater for the trainer, the
supervisor and the trainee or the becoming
psychotherapist at the end of the training
programme. Regardless all this not all colleagues
will practice psychotherapy. Some of them will
give up after the first modules of training and
others continue their training and supervision in
psychotherapy for a personal development and
most of them have two jobs. Little of them will
make a career in psychotherapy. Remaining a
psychotherapist supposes being at an intersection
between theory, practice and research. A
psychotherapist is treated with respect and he is
permanently
preoccupied
with
interviews,
supervision and maintaining a state of mental
hygiene. An association of professional
development in psychotherapy may easily gain
room on the market, but it can lose it in the same
easy manner. Trainers have a great responsibility
in the training and the becoming of
psychotherapist, and the trainees represents the
mirror of development, maintaining and
recognizing the supplier of professional
development.
REFERENCES
1. Kaslow, N., Psychotherapy Bulletin,
President*s Column (2009).
2. Kaslow, N., Competencies in professional
psychology, American Psychologist, (2004).
3. Sperry, L., Highly effective therapy:
Developing essential clinical competencies
in counselling and psychotherapy. New
York: Routledge (2010).
4. Sperry. L., Competencies in Counselling
and Psychotherapy: Becoming a Highly
competent
and
Effective
Therapist,
Routledge, Taylor & Francis Group (2010).
5. Skovholt, T., &Jennings, L., Master
therapists. Exploring expertise in therapy
and counselling. Boston: Alleyn & Bacon.
(2004).
688
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
689
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
extremely
safe
and
non
invasive measurement
very quick measurement: because the
set of interest parameters are directly
measured by the application of the
palms on the biosensor for a very short
period
of
time,
the BioSpecter Psychometric System
does not use classical evaluation tests,
sometimes long and tiresome, difficult
to cross and with a big dose of
subjectivity with the possibility to
memorise the responses to repeated
tests or more unpleasant, by limiting
the possibility of evaluation of the
cognitive intelligence on the level of
intelligence of the test author;
692
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
693
AIR FORCE
694
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
695
AIR FORCE
Personality function it is
associated
with
the
formation
and
development of the desired personality and
professional traits of the pilot (trainee),
preparing him for it, among others, for air
mission execution under high workload and/or
time deficit, and in new situations (onboard
and in the mission environment) from the
point of view of the current pilot (trainee)
experience, etc.
Control-examination function it
allows to carry out control/examination
696
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
697
AIR FORCE
698
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
13
10
11
699
12
AIR FORCE
organizations in Poland 16 indicate that FNPT2 simulators provide highly effective training
and selection, particularly in relation to the
exercises concerning: IFR flights, emergency
procedures, maneuvers performed by the
aircraft during mission execution, and cockpit
pre-flight check.
Given the above findings, it is possible to
formulate a thesis that modern flight
simulators ensure a high degree of basic flight
training efficiency 17 . Other air training
equipment, due to its purpose and specific use
is not used by
general flight training
organizations.
USEFULLNES OF THE FLICHT
SIMULATORS IN THE COMMERCIAL
AVIATION PILOTS TRAINING
Commercial
aviation
organizations
following the current regulations conduct the
simulator training within the scope of training
for certain aircraft type, MCC, CRM, and
mandatory periodic training. The main
document regulating the air operator's duties
regarding the preparation and professional
development training of the crews belonging
to commercial aviation organizations is OPS1, and Part-FCL1 in relation to the training for
particular aircraft type. As is the case with
general aviation, each flight simulator or air
training equipment item replacing the aircraft
for training and testing purposes must be
certified in accordance with the requirements
applicable to air training equipment 18 . Under
the current regulations, any member of the
flight crew prior to commencing flight
operations below the standard set for Cat. I,
operations outside the standard of Cat. II and
operations within Category II and III 19 must
16
17
14
15
18
19
700
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
701
23
24
AIR FORCE
25
26
702
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
psychology and human factors, CRC Press, New the simulation training.
Simulator training can be divided into
York 2010, p. 43.
29
T.R. Carreta, Transfer of training effectiveness in three areas 31 :
flight simulation: 1986 1997 (technical report
AFRL-HE-AZ-TR-1998-0078), Mesa, AZ: U.S. Air
Force Research Laboratory, Human Effectiveness
Directorate, (in:) Op.cit., M. Martinussen, D.R.
Hunter, Aviation Psychology and Human Factors,
p. 114.
703
30
AIR FORCE
704
2
Procedural training (IFR)
3
Tactical
training
Flight
maneuver
training
Non-routine
situation training
airport;
32
A. Bondaruk, Badanie wpywu uszkodze i
maintaining the prescribed
niesprawnoci samolotu wielozadaniowego na
heading
during
the vectoring;
bezpieczestwo lotw [Study of failure and malfunction
descending
to
the
final
effect in multi-role aircraft on flight safety], Doctoral
approach point (FAP), maintaining the
Dissertation, Air Force Institute of Technology (ITWL),
Warsaw 2011.
705
AIR FORCE
Fig. 2.
The total number (sum) of errors committed by pilots during the execution of
tasks in accordance with scenario No. 1
706
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Fig. 3.
The total number (sum) of errors committed by pilots during the execution
of tasks in accordance with scenario No. 2
707
AIR FORCE
Fig. 4
Sums of the numbers characterizing the errors made during the task
execution by the pilots, and the execution of tasks during an emergency
situation according to the developed scenarios No. 1 and No. 2
(
number of errors
number of tasks executed)
the air. At the same time, there is a noticeable
Analyzing the number of errors made and decrease in the number of errors as a function
the tasks executed, one can conclude that of the number of repetitions of a given
during the execution of tasks in accordance scenario.
with scenario No. 1 and No. 2, pilot No. 6 was
Basic statistics, including mean values
best prepared for the emerging situations, and standard deviation, were calculated on the
whereas pilot No. 2 was the worst.
basis of the data obtained during the
Acting in accordance with the presented simulation of specific situations that
scheme does not allow one to draw definite characterized the level of training of a
conclusions concerning the proper way of particular group of pilots who executed tasks
approaching the problem of pilot training. The using an F-16 aircraft simulator.
Presentation of these values in a scatter
characteristics under analysis are different in
their nature, and it cannot be decided graph [Figure 5] allows for the disclosure of
unequivocally which pilot has to undergo the four basic structures of meeting the
additional training and which does not, and requirements by pilots involved in the training
what number of additional flights will allow a system. Those structures have been defined on
given pilot to acquire the appropriate the basis of an analysis of the number of errors
responses to simulated specific situations in made in emergency situations.
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
Fig. 6.
.
The system is characterized by
concentrated satisfaction with the results
achieved by pilots, No. 3, 4, 6, and 10. Such a
situation is perceived by the training system in
a coherent and consistent manner.
709
AIR FORCE
710
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
take-off, mission execution, landing, psotflight check) to discuss and repeat a specific
part of the exercise by the trainee. It facilitates
the repetition of each flight element and
making breaks for an exchange of views
between the trainee and the instructor.
5. Predictability. Simulator training
prevents the occurrence of such dangerous
phenomena as air traffic collision, wind shear,
icing, weather deterioration, turbulence,
closure of airports, etc. Of course, all of these
situations are possible to simulate, but the
exercise of this kind are carried out by the
trainee at the time specified by the instructor,
according to the trainee's progress made in the
training.
6. Learning from mistakes with
unlimited possibilities of applying a number of
ways to solve an in-flight operational problem
with "zero" risk level, the simulator allows the
student to select the solution which is the most
optimal from his perspective and to test it.
This capability allows the trainee to physically
"prove to himself" that some solutions
considered by him to be more useful and safer
than those recommended by the instructor or
the instruction manuals are not a good option
in operational reality and, consequently, they
are eliminated by the trainee once and for all.
7. Maintaining pilot currency and
proper attention allocation. Systematic
training exercises on the flight simulator
allows the trainee to consolidate the desired
habits (maintain pilot currency) and, what is
equally important, allows him to permanently
master the optimal attention allocation in
various phases of the air mission execution. It
allows the beginner pilot, on the other hand, to
adequately master the basic elements of
cockpit preflight check and such actions as
711
AIR FORCE
33
HENRI COANDA
AIR FORCE ACADEMY
ROMANIA
AIR FORCE
714